Advances in Spinal Stabilization PDF
Advances in Spinal Stabilization PDF
Advances in Spinal Stabilization PDF
dramroo
Progress in Neurological
Surgery
Vol. 16
Series Editor
dramroo
Advances in Spinal
Stabilization
Volume Editors
dramroo
Regis W. Haid, Jr., MD
Emory University School of Medicine
Department of Neurosurgery
The Emory Clinic
Atlanta, GA 30322 (USA)
Advances in spinal stabilization / volume editors, Regis W. Haid, Jr., Brian R. Subach,
Gerald E, Rodts, Jr.
p. ; cm. (Progress in neurological surgery, ISSN 00796492 ; vol. 16)
1. SpineSurgery. 2. Spinal implants. I. Haid, Regis W. II. Subach, Brian R. III. Rodts,
617.56059dc21 2003047736
Bibliographic Indices. This publication is listed in bibliographic services, including Current Contents and
Index Medicus.
Drug Dosage. The authors and the publisher have exerted every effort to ensure that drug selection and
dosage set forth in this text are in accord with current recommendations and practice at the time of publication.
However, in view of ongoing research, changes in government regulations, and the constant flow of information
relating to drug therapy and drug reactions, the reader is urged to check the package insert for each drug for
any change in indications and dosage and for added warnings and precautions. This is particularly important
when the recommended agent is a new and/or infrequently employed drug.
All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be translated into other languages, reproduced or
utilized in any form or by any means electronic or mechanical, including photocopying, recording, microcopying,
or by any information storage and retrieval system, without permission in writing from the publisher.
dramroo
Contents
IX Foreword
Sonntag, V.K.H. (Phoenix, Ariz.)
Biological Advances
dramroo
Neuronavigational Advances
Contents VI
dramroo
240 Vertebral Augmentation for Osteoporotic and Osteolytic
Vertebral Compression Fractures: Vertebroplasty
and Kyphoplasty
Lieberman, I. (Cleveland, Ohio)
Socio-Economic Evolution
Contents VII
dramroo
Series Editors Note
Three eminent spine surgeons have collaborated as editors for this volume
of Progress in Neurological Surgery. There is no question that new spinal sta
bilization techniques, minimally invasive approaches to the spine, and new con
cepts of biomechanics have revolutionized our understanding of disorders of
spinal stability. In this comprehensive volume, the authors describe various
techniques and clinically relevant procedures designed to improve the outcomes
of spine surgery. Neuronavigational techniques, new bone fusion concepts, and
both open and percutaneous spinal stabilization techniques are described.
Progress in Neurological Surgery is dedicated to providing timely updates of
important neurosurgical paradigm shifts. The volume of spinal surgery across
the world has dramatically increased. The chapters in volume 16 help to eluci
date the role and rationale of these new kinds of spinal stabilization. I am grate
ful to the editorial efforts of Dr. Haid, Dr. Subach and Dr. Rodts and to all the
authors.
L. Dade Lunsford, MD
VIII
dramroo
Foreword
Spinal stabilization has changed dramatically over the last 10 years and the
pace of change continues to accelerate. This volume is an excellent mirror of
the evolution of spinal stabilization from the nuts, rods, and bolts first used
years ago to the current applications of bilateral fusion using bone morpho
genetic protein and gene manipulation or sophisticated bone extenders. Further
possibilities for stabilizing the spine, as reflected in this book, include
absorbable stabilization devices.
Through the combination of technical advances in minimally invasive
spine surgery and neuronavigation, spinal surgery will become less destructive,
less painful, and more successful. Most importantly, patient outcomes will
improve. The section on instrumentation and technique represents the most
up-to-date advances in surgical technique and management of spinal disorders.
The authors have provided a valuable service by compiling the most recent
advances in spinal stabilization. This volume is a welcome addition to the per
sonal libraries of spinal surgeons and to institutional libraries.
V.K.H. Sonntag
IX
dramroo
This page intentionally left blank
dramroo
Biological Advances
Over 30 years ago, Urist et al. [67, 68] identified a group of protein
extracts, derived from the ground substance of mature bovine bone, capable of
inducing both cartilage and bone formation when implanted into the soft tissues
of study animals. Aptly named, bone morphogenetic proteins (BMPs) by Urist,
these glycoproteins comprise a subset of the transforming growth factor-
family of related growth and differentiation factors. Of the more than 20 BMPs
isolated to date, 6 appear to be structurally related to each other and capable of
initiating the process of endochondral bone formation. The presence of such
factors within the matrix of mature bone indicates a likely role in the regenera
tion and remodeling of bony structures after injury or repetitive stresses [4, 9,
18, 24, 43, 44].
Subach/Haid/Rodts/Petraglia 2
dramroo
Some cells respond to the growth factor aspect of BMP by altering their
rates of proliferation. Yamaguchi et al. [71] demonstrated this in vitro by quan
tifying cellular proliferation of the rat C26 calvarial osteoprogenitor cells after
treatment with BMP-2. This BMP-2 effect, however, appears to maintain speci
ficity for certain cell types. For example, although BMP-7 has been shown to
be mitogenic for a human osteosarcoma cell line (TE-85), treatment with BMP-2
showed no measurable effect on proliferation. In contrast, treatment of an
osteoblast cell line (MC3T3-E1) with BMP-4 results in an inhibition of growth
and a globally diminished proliferative index. By the effects on both mature and
immature cell types, it seems reasonable that BMPs must be involved in the
regulation of bone growth and maintenance of bone structure.
BMPs may also initiate the differentiation of stem cells into a specific
phenotype. For example, the rat calvarial stem cell line (C26) is considered
multipotential, in that such cells may be precursors for adipocytes, muscle cells,
or osteoblasts. When BMP-2 is added to the culture medium, such cells become
mature osteoblasts with increased surface expression of receptors for parathy
roid hormone, alkaline phosphatase, and calcitonin [71]. This effect may also
be observed in bone marrow cells. For example, the mouse line of marrow cells
(W-20-17) may differentiate into either adipocytes or osteoblasts, depending
upon the specific hormonal influence. The BMP-2 treatment of such cells
results in both the differentiation of the cells into osteoblasts and the surface
expression of receptors normally seen on mature cells.
Sources of BMP
At present there are three ways to obtain bone growth and differentiation fac
tors: extraction of the factors from animal or human bone matrix, production of a
single factor by cellular hosts using recombinant technology, and direct delivery of
the DNA encoding for the factor to cells at the site of desired bone formation.
The first of these was initially employed by Urist et al. [67, 68]. From
massive quantities of bovine bone, the group was able to extract a mixture of
proteins found to stimulate bone growth in vivo. Under clinical evaluation in
Europe as NeOsteo (Sulzer Spinetech, Wheat Ridge, Colo., USA), this mixture
of BMPs and other associated proteins is derived through a well-engineered
isolation process. The precise combination of factors comprising this substance
has not yet been fully characterized, but appears to be reproducible through the
manufacturers process. This substance has shown experimental promise in
bridging both segment skeletal defects in dogs and in bringing about spinal
fusion in animal models of posterolateral arthrodesis. [12, 14, 17, 26, 27]. Like
other growth and differentiation factors, a carrier substance is necessary to
BMP Update 3
dramroo
maintain adequate concentrations at the site of fusion. Substances such as
natural coral (hydroxyapatite), collagen, and calcium sulfate have each been
investigated [26, 27].
The second method of obtaining bone growth and differentiation factors
has previously been discussed (see Molecular Biology). The process of obtain
ing recombinant human BMPs such as rhBMP-2 (Medtronic Sofamor Danek,
Memphis, Tenn., USA and Genetics Institute, Cambridge, Mass., USA) and
rhBMP-7 (Stryker Biotech, Hopkinton, Mass., USA) has been described. Such
proteins differ from mixtures of extracted substances, mainly in terms of purity
of product. Original studies of these substances focused upon animal models of
segmental bone defects in the appendicular skeleton of rats, sheep, and dogs
[23, 24, 35]. Cole et al. [23] compared rhBMP in a carrier to autologous graft
ing in a skeletal defect model with considerable success. Gerhart et al. [35]
showed the utility of rhBMP in healing segmental femoral defects in sheep.
Shortly thereafter, recombinant BMP was applied to animal models of spinal
fusion and later, humans.
The third strategy for engineering bone formation involves gene therapy, or
the delivery of the appropriate gene, or cDNA encoding for BMP to the local
cells, rather than the actual factor. There are two obvious benefits to the strategy
as compared to recombinant technology. First, the cost of genetic manipulation
is significantly less than that required to both produce and market the purified
rhBMP. Second, the potential for prolonged local production of the factor is
greater with gene therapy when compared to the relatively short-lived effect of
the rhBMP/carrier complex. Attempts to introduce BMP-2 cDNA into animal
models are preliminary, but have met with limited success [1, 17, 29, 70].
Subach/Haid/Rodts/Petraglia 4
dramroo
a b
Fig. 1. Photomicrograph of intertransverse spinal fusion using carrier matrix alone (a)
as a control and rhBMP-2/carrier (b). Histologic section demonstrates transverse processes
at inferior-lateral corners with bridging collagen scar tissue and minimal bone formation (a)
and abundant new membranous bone formation (b).
BMP Update 5
dramroo
Control 0.75 mg/ml 1.50 mg/ml
Fig. 2. Threaded titanium interbody cage implanted into the lumbar spine of a primate.
Control group is cage alone. Experimental groups are rhBMP-2-impregnated sponges at con
centrations of 0.75 and 1.50 mg/ml. Actual spines at 6 months from surgery. Control demon
strates a pseudarthrosis with fibrous scar tissue within the cage. BMP groups both show
mature bone bridging the interspace within the cage.
Subach/Haid/Rodts/Petraglia 6
dramroo
a b
c d
Control rhBMP-2
Fig. 3. Bone dowel interbody device implanted into the lumbar spine of a primate.
Control group is dowel with autograft. Experimental group is a bone dowel with an rhBMP-2
impregnated sponge inside. Actual spines at 6 months from surgery. Control group demon
strates a solid fusion (a) and reabsorption of the bone dowel/autograft construct (c). BMP
animals (b, d) both show mature bone bridging the interspace with resorption of the dowel.
BMP Update 7
dramroo
Patient 11 rhBMP-2
c
6 months 12 months 24 months
The cages attempt to both restore and maintain intervertebral height and protect
the BMP from exposure to diluting substances such as blood and irrigation fluid.
Although approved, BMP has yet to reach the market. Concerns raised by
experts include the improper use of the BMP such that vascular and neural ele
ments may come in contact with the protein causing injury, lower fusion rates
due to improper or unapproved implantation techniques, and stimulation of
infectious or neoplastic processes due to use in patients with such diseases.
Discussion
Research over the past decade has shown the utility of using the growth
and differentiation factor, BMP-2, to promote bone formation at the site of bone
loss or injury. The in vivo role of BMP-2 and its complex interaction with other
Subach/Haid/Rodts/Petraglia 8
dramroo
growth and differentiation factors remains to be clarified. The use of BMP-2 as
a means of replacing harvested autograft and obviating the need for internal fix
ation, each with its attendant morbidity, appears likely as a result of outcomes
from both animal and human studies. Although dose-effect relationships and
carrier substrates may provide continued investigational challenges, the use of
recombinant technology and gene therapy in the field of bone fusion have been
firmly established. In the past 30 years since Marshall Urist first coined the
term bone morphogenetic protein, one doubts that he could have envisioned the
monumental strides and clinical progress, which researchers in the field have
achieved to this point.
Conclusions
Acknowledgments
The authors wish to thank Medtronic Sofamor Danek for their continued support and
assistance in the preparation of the figures.
References
1 Aronow MA, Gerstenfeld LC, Owen TA, Tassinari MS, Stein GS, Lian JB: Factors that promote
progressive development of the osteoblast phenotype in cultured rat calvarial cells. J Cell Physiol
1990;143:213221.
BMP Update 9
dramroo
2 Arrington ED, Smith WJ, Chambers HG, Bucknell AL, Davino NA: Complications of iliac crest
bone graft harvesting. Clin Orthop 1996;329:300309.
3 Asahina I, Sampath TK, Nishimura I, Hauschka PV: Human osteogenic protein-1 induces both
chondroblastic and osteoblastic differentiation of osteoprogenitor cells derived from newborn rat
calvaria. J Cell Biol 1993;123:921933.
4 Aspenberg P, Jeppsson C, Wang JS, Bostrom M: Transforming growth factor beta and bone mor
phogenetic protein 2 for bone ingrowth: A comparison using bone chambers in rats. Bone 1996;
19:499503.
5 Aspenberg P, Turek T: BMP-2 for intramuscular bone induction: Effect in squirrel monkeys is
dependent on implantation site. Acta Orthop Scand 1996;67:36.
6 Banwart JC, Asher MA, Hassanein RS: Iliac crest bone graft harvest donor site morbidity: A sta
tistical evaluation. Spine 1995;20:10551060.
7 Boden SD, Hair G, Titus L, Racine M, McCuaig K, Wozney JM, Nanes MS: Glucocorticoid-
induced differentiation of fetal rat calvarial osteoblasts is mediated by BMP-6. Endocrinology
1997;138:29202928.
8 Boden SD, Martin GJ, Horton WC, Truss TL, Sandhu HS: Laparoscopic anterior spinal arthrod
esis with rhBMP-2 in a titanium interbody threaded cage. J Spinal Disord 1998;11:95101.
9 Boden SD, McCuaig K, Hair G, Racine M, Titus L, Wozney JM, Nanes MS: Differential effects
and glucocorticoid potentiation of bone morphogenetic protein action during rat osteoblast differ
entiation in vitro. Endocrinology 1996;137:34013407.
10 Boden SD, Moskovitz PA, Morone MA, Toribitake Y: Video-assisted lateral intertransverse
process arthrodesis: Validation of a new minimally invasive lumbar spinal fusion technique in the
rabbit and nonhuman primate (rhesus) models. Spine 1996;21:26892697.
11 Boden SD, Schimandle JH: Biologic enhancement of spinal fusion. Spine 1995;20(suppl):
S113S123.
12 Boden SD, Schimandle JH, Hutton WC: 1995 Volvo Award in basic sciences. The use of an
osteoinductive growth factor for lumbar spinal fusion. II. Study of dose, carrier, and species. Spine
1995;20:26332644.
13 Boden SD, Schimandle JH, Hutton WC: Lumbar intertransverse-process spine arthrodesis using a
bovine-derived osteoinductive bone protein. J Bone Joint Surg Am 1995;77:14041417.
14 Boden SD, Schimandle JH, Hutton WC: Evaluation of a bovine-derived osteoinductive bone
protein in a non-human primate model of lumbar spinal fusion. Trans Orthop Res Soc 1996;
21:118.
15 Boden SD, Schimandle JH, Hutton WC, Damien CJ, Benedict JJ, Baranowski C, Collier S: In vivo
evaluation of a resorbable osteoinductive composite as a graft substitute for lumbar spinal fusion.
J Spinal Disord 1997;10:111.
16 Boden SD, Sumner DR: Biologic factors affecting spinal fusion and bone regeneration. Spine
1995;20(suppl):102S112S.
17 Boden SD, Titus L, Hair G, Liu Y, Viggeswarapu M, Nanes MS, Baranowski C: 1998 Volvo Award
in basic sciences: Lumbar spine fusion by local gene therapy with a cDNA encoding a novel
osteoinductive protein (LMP-I). Spine 1998;23:24862492.
18 Boonen S, Broos P, Dequeker J, Bouillon R: The prevention or treatment of age-related osteo
porosis in the elderly by systemic recombinant growth factor therapy (rhIGF-I or rhTGF beta):
A perspective. J Intern Med 1997;242:285290.
19 Burns BH: An operation for spondylolisthesis. Lancet 1933;224:i233.
20 Calandruccio RA, Benton BF: Anterior lumbar fusion. Clin Orthop 1964;35:6368.
21 Caplan AI: Mesenchymal stem cells. J Orthop Res 1991;9:641650.
22 Centrella M, McCarthy TL, Canalis E: Current concepts review: Transforming growth factor-beta
and remodeling of bone. J Bone Joint Surg Am 1991;73:14181428.
23 Cole BJ, Yasko A, Browne MA: The ability of recombinant human bone morphogenetic protein to
heal segmental bone defects A comparison of physiologic carriers to autologous bone graft.
J Bone Miner Res 1992;7(suppl):S251.
24 Cook SD, Baffes GC, Wolfe MW, Sampath TK, Rueger DC, Whitecloud TS 3rd: The effect of
recombinant human osteogenic protein-1 on healing of large segmental bone defects. J Bone Joint
Surg Am 1994;76:827838.
Subach/Haid/Rodts/Petraglia 10
dramroo
25 Cook SD, Dalton JE, Tan EH, Whitecloud T, Rueger DC: In vivo evaluation of recombinant human
osteogenic protein (rhOP-1) implants as a bone graft substitute for spinal fusions. Spine 1994;19:
16551663.
26 Damien CJ, Christel PS, Benedict JJ, Patat J-L, Guillemin G: A composite of natural coral, colla
gen, bone protein, and basic fibroblast growth factor tested in a rat subcutaneous model. Ann Chir
Gynaecol 1993;82:117128.
27 Damien CJ, Parsons JR, Benedict JJ, Weisman DS: Investigation of a hydroxyapatite and calcium
sulfate composite supplemented with an osteoinductive factor. J Biomed Mater Res 1990;24:
639654.
28 David SM, Murakami T, Tabor OB, Grub HE, Meyer RA Jr, Howard BA, Wozney JM, Hanley EN Jr:
Lumbar spinal fusion using recombinant human bone morphogenetic protein-2 (rhBMP-2): A ran
domized, blinded and controlled study. Trans In Soc Study Lumbar Spine 1995;22:14.
29 Delloye C, Verhelpen M, DHemricourt J, Govaerts B, Bourgois R: Morphometric and physical
investigations of segmental cortical bone autografts and allografts in canine ulnar defects. Clin
Orthop 1992;282:273292.
30 Fairbank JCT, Davies JB, Mbaot JC, OBrien JP: The Oswestry low back pain disability ques
tionnaire. Physiotherapy 1980;66:271273.
31 Fang J, Zhu YY, Smiley E, Bonadio J, Rouleau JP, Goldstein SA, McCauley LK, Davidson BL,
Roessler BJ: Stimulation of new bone formation by direct transfer of osteogenic plasmid genes.
Proc Natl Acad Sci USA 1996;93:57535758.
32 Fernyhough JC, Schimandle JH, Weigel MC, Edwards CC, Levine AM: Chronic donor site pain
complicating bone graft harvesting from the posterior iliac crest for spinal fusion. Spine 1992;
17:14741480.
33 Fischgrund JS, James SB, Chabot MC, Hankin R, Herkowitz HN, Wozney JM, Shirkhoda A:
Augmentation of autograft using rhBMP-2 and different carrier media in the canine spine fusion
model. J Spinal Disord 1997;10:467472.
34 Fraser RD: Interbody, posterior, and combined lumbar fusions. Spine 1995;20(suppl):
S167S177.
35 Gerhart TN, Kirker-Head CA, Kriz MJ, Holtrop ME, Hennig GE, Hipp J, Schelling SH, Wang E:
Healing segmental femoral defects in sheep using recombinant human bone morphogenetic pro
tein. Clin Orthop 1993;293:317326.
36 Goldberg VM, Stevenson S: Natural history of autografts and allografts. Clin Orthop 1987;225:
716.
37 Goldberg VM, Stevenson S, Shaffer JW: Biology of autografts and allografts; in Friedlaender GE,
Goldberg VM (eds): Bone and Cartilage Allografts. Park Ridge, American Academy of Orthopaedic
Surgeons, 1991, pp 312.
38 Goulet JA, Senunas LE, DeSilva GL, Greenfield MLVH: Autogenous iliac crest bone graft. Clin
Orthop 1997;339:7681.
39 Grevitt M, Khazim R, Webb J, Mulholland R, Shepperd J: The short form-36 health survey ques
tionnaire in spine surgery. J Bone Joint Surg Br 1997;79:4852.
40 Hanisch O, Tatakis DN, Boskovic MM, Rohrer MD, Wikesjo UM: Bone formation and reosseoin
tegration in peri-implantitis defects following surgical implantation of rhBMP-2. Int J Oral
Maxillofac Implants 1997;12:604610.
41 Hanisch O, Tatakis DN, Rohrer MD, Wohrle PS, Wozney JM, Wikesjo UM: Bone formation and
osseointegration stimulated by rhBMP-2 following subantral augmentation procedures in nonhu
man primates. Int J Oral Maxillofac Implants 1997;12:785792.
42 Harmon PH: Anterior extraperitoneal lumbar disk excision and vertebral fusion. Clin Orthop
1960;18:169198.
43 Heiple KG, Chase SW, Herndon CH: A comparative study of the healing process following
different types of bone transplantation. J Bone Joint Surg Am 1963;45:15931616.
44 Hogan BLM: Bone morphogenetic proteins: Multi-functional regulators of vertebrate develop
ment. Genes Dev 1996;10:15801594.
45 Holliger EH, Trawick RH, Boden SD, Hutton WC: Morphology of the lumbar intertransverse
process fusion mass in the rabbit model: A comparison between two bone graft materials rhBMP-2
and autograft. J Spinal Disord 1996;9:125128.
BMP Update 11
dramroo
46 Kim SS, Denis F, Lonstein JE, Winter RB: Factors affecting fusion rate in spondylolisthesis. Spine
1990;15:977984.
47 Kozak JA, Heilman AE, OBrien JP: Anterior lumbar fusion operations: Technique and graft mate
rials. Clin Orthop 1994;300:4551.
48 Kumar A, Kozak JA, Doherty BJ, Dickson JH: Interspace distraction and graft subsidence after
anterior lumbar fusion with femoral strut allograft. Spine 1993;18:23932400.
49 Kuslich SD, Ulstrom CL, Griffith SL, Ahern JW, Dowdle JD: The Bagby and Kuslich method of
lumbar interbody fusion. Spine 1998;23:12671279.
50 Laurie SWS, Kaban LB, Mulliken JB, Murray JE: Donor-site morbidity after harvesting rib and
iliac bone. Plast Reconstr Surg 1984;73:933938.
51 Martin GJ, Boden SD, Morone MA, Moskovitz PA: Posterolateral intertransverse process spinal
fusion arthrodesis with rhBMP-2 in a non-human primate: Important lessons learned regarding
dose, carrier, and safety. J Spinal Disord 1999;12:179186.
52 McHorney CA, Ware JE, Lu R, Sherbourne CD: The MOS 36-item short form health survey
(SF-36). III. Tests of data quality, scaling assumptions, and reliability across diverse groups. Med Care
1994;32:4066.
53 Muschler GF, Hyodo A, Manning T, Kambic H, Easley K: Evaluation of human bone morpho
genetic protein 2 in a canine spinal fusion model. Clin Orthop 1994;308:229240.
54 Rawlinson N: Morbidity after anterior cervical decompression and fusion: The influence of the
donor site on recovery, and the results of a trial of surgibone compared to autologous bone. Acta
Neurochir 1994;131:106118.
55 Ray CD: Threaded titanium cages for lumbar interbody fusions. Spine 1997;22:667680.
56 Sacks S: Anterior interbody fusion of the lumbar spine: Indications and results in 200 cases. Clin
Orthop 1966;44:163170.
57 Sandhu HS, Kabo IM, Turner AS, Liu D, Kanim LEA, Toth IM: RhBMP-2 augmentation of tita
nium fusion cages for experimental anterior lumbar fusion. Proceedings of the 11th Annual
Meeting of the North American Spine Society. Rosemont, North American Spine Society, 1996,
p 47.
58 Sandhu HS, Kanim LE, Kabo JM, Toth JM, Zeegen EN, Liu D, Delamarter RB, Dawson EG:
Effective doses of recombinant bone morphogenetic protein-2 in experimental spinal fusion.
Spine 1996;21:21152122.
59 Sandhu HS, Kanim LE, Kabo JM, Toth JM, Zeegan EN, Liu D, Seeger LL, Dawson EG:
Evaluation of rhBMP-2 with an OPLA carrier in a canine posterolateral (transverse process)
spinal fusion model. Spine 1995;20:26692682.
60 Sandhu HS, Kanim LE, Toth JM, Kabo JM, Liu D, Delamarter RB, Dawson EG: Experimental
spinal fusion with recombinant human bone morphogenetic protein-2 without decortication of
osseous elements. Spine 1997;22:11711180.
61 Shimandle JH, Boden SO, Hutton WC: Experimental spinal fusion with recombinant human bone
morphogenetic protein-2 (rhBMP-2). Spine 1995;20:13261337.
62 Scene CL, Freeze A, Weil RJ, Marquette PJ: Analysis of harvest morbidity and radiographic out
come using autograft for anterior cervical fusion. Spine 1997;22:22222227.
63 Schuster JJ: CRC Handbook of Sample Size: Guidelines for Clinical Trial. Boca Raton, CRC
Press, 1990.
64 Sorenson KH: Anterior interbody lumbar spine fusion for incapacitating disc degeneration and
spondylolisthesis. Acta Orthop Scand 1978;49:269277.
65 Stauffer RN, Coventry MB: Anterior interbody lumbar spine fusion. J Bone Joint Surg Am
1972;54:756768.
66 Stewart AL, Hays RD, Ware JE: The MOS short form general health survey (SF-36). Med Care
1988;26:724732.
67 Urist MR: Bone. Formation by autoinduction. Science 1965;150:893899.
68 Urist MR, Strates BS: Bone morphogenetic protein. J Dent Res 1971;50:13921406.
69 Ware JE, Sherbourne CD: The MOS 36-item short form health survey (SF-36). I. Conceptual
framework and item selection. Med Care 1992;30:473483.
70 Wozney JM: Bone morphogenetic proteins and their gene expression; in Noda M (ed): Cellular
and Molecular Biology of Bone. Boston, Academic Press, 1993, pp 131167.
Subach/Haid/Rodts/Petraglia 12
dramroo
71 Yamaguchi A, Katagiri T, Ikeda T, Wozney JM, Rosen V, Wang EA, Kahn AJ, Suda T, Yoshiki S:
Recombinant human bone morphogenetic protein stimulates osteoblastic maturation and inhibits
myogenic differentiation in vitro. J Cell Biol 1991;113:681687.
72 Younger EM, Chapman MW: Morbidity at bone graft donor sites. J Orthop Trauma 1989;3:
192195.
73 Zdeblick TA, Ghanayem AJ, Rapoff AJ, Swain C, Bassett T, Cooke ME, Markel M: Cervical inter-
body fusion cages: An animal model with and without bone morphogenetic protein. Spine
1998;23:758766.
BMP Update 13
dramroo
Haid RW Jr, Subach BR, Rodts GE Jr (eds): Advances in Spinal Stabilization.
dramroo
differentiation factors. By supplying stem cells to the site, the growth factor
response is not dependent solely on the availability of local stem cell popula
tions, which may be diminished due to senility, radiation, medical factors, or
medications which might alter the intrinsic stem cell population. Therefore,
direct implantation of pluripotent cells with or without growth factors has the
potential to yield more rapid and uniform bony healing. Osteoprogenitor cells
have been isolated from the bone marrow of rats, rabbits, dogs, and humans, as
well as nonmarrow locations such as adipose tissue. These cells can be isolated
and expanded in tissue culture, prior to implantation into a target location. Stem
cells also have the potential to be genetically altered to express various growth
factors or other therapeutic genes prior to implantation.
A variety of studies have demonstrated the utility of using stem cells to
achieve bone formation. Bruder et al. [1] placed autologous canine MSCs
obtained from bone marrow onto porous cylinders composed of hydroxyapatite
and tricalcium phosphate. The implant was subsequently grafted into critical-
sized femoral defects. Implants without MSCs produced atrophic nonunions in
all treated animals. Implants containing the MSCs produced lamellar and
woven bone within the carrier and resulted in a solid union at the site of the
defect. Bruder et al. [2] also successfully achieved bone induction using human
MSCs on a ceramic carrier in athymic nude rats. Using radiography, biome
chanical testing, and histologic analysis, the human MSCs were capable of
healing critical-sized femoral defects. Quarto et al. [3] studied the use of autol
ogous bone marrow stromal cells delivered on a macroporous hydroxyapatite
carrier for the healing of large bony defects (4.0 cm) in a small human clinical
series. The implant was placed within the defect, and the fracture was stabilized
with external fixation. In each instance, the composite implant was able to
achieve successful union of the bony defect, thus producing the first direct
evidence that tissue engineering of bone can be successfully applied to humans
in a clinical setting.
Helm/Anderson 16
dramroo
Viral Vectors
Adenoviral Vectors. Adenoviruses are double-stranded DNA viruses
which bind to specific cell surface receptors, enter the cells by endocytosis, and
subsequently release their DNA into the cytoplasm [45, 46]. The viral genome
is divided into immediate early genes, early genes, and late genes according to
the time in which the genes are expressed. The immediate early genes activate
early gene transcription, while the early genes are involved both in subsequent
viral replication and host immune evasion. The late genes code for the aden
oviruses structural proteins [46]. Most adenoviral vectors studied to date are
derived from the adenovirus serotype-5, which are rendered replication-
defective by deletion of the E1 region. The E3 region is often deleted as well to
make room for larger transgenes. First generation adenoviral vectors can
accommodate up to 8 kb of foreign DNA.
The advantages of adenoviral vectors include their ability to be produced in
high titers, their extrachromosomal life cycle, which reduces the risk of insertional
mutagenesis, and their ability to transfect numerous cell types [46, 47]. There are
several potential disadvantages of the adenoviral vector for gene therapy. Because
the virus does not integrate into the cellular genome, the length of gene expression
is limited and therapeutic genes are not passed to the progeny of the transduced
cells. Perhaps the most problematic issue with adenoviral vectors, however, is the
robust humoral and cellular immune response that can occur at the treatment site
resulting in reduced transgene expression. Intense research efforts are currently
directed at blunting the immune response by alterations to the adenoviral vector
such as deleting the viral DNA polymerase gene (pol adenoviral vectors) or
completely eliminating the viral genome (gutless adenoviral vectors).
AAV Vectors. AAV, which are defective single-stranded DNA parvoviruses,
are also attractive vectors for BMP gene therapy studies [48]. AAV vectors have
the ability to integrate stably into the target cells genome, transduce a variety of
cell types, maintain high levels of gene expression, transfect both proliferating
and quiescent cells, and be generated in high titers. Numerous studies have
demonstrated that AAV can efficiently transduce muscle and other cells in vivo
with little inflammatory response and no evidence of insertional mutagenesis.
The production of AAV vectors was initially fraught with numerous technical
difficulties; however, current techniques of vector production lead to a high yield
of recombinant AAV, completely free of wild-type AAV.
Retroviral Vectors. Retroviral vectors enter target cells through interac
tions between the viral envelope proteins and cell surface glycoproteins.
Importantly, retroviruses contain single-stranded RNA. Once the viral genome
is released into the cytoplasm, retroviral reverse transcriptase produces a double-
stranded DNA copy, which subsequently integrates into the host genome
during mitosis. One disadvantage to using retroviral vectors is that retroviruses
Nonviral Vectors
Direct Plasmid Injection. Wolff [51] was the first to show that the direct
intramuscular injection of plasmid DNA could lead to low level, short-term
gene expression. Other researchers have now demonstrated the successful
transduction of the myocardium, brain, thyroid, and various tumors using this
technique [5255]. Inadequate cellular transduction rates can be significantly
increased by pretreatment of the injected area with hypertonic saline or bupi
vacaine [56]. Systemic gene expression can also be obtained by the direct intra
venous injection of naked DNA in adults, although rapid degradation of the
DNA prior to reaching the target cell remains problematic in the absence of a
delivery system, such as cationic liposomes [57]. Currently, no published stud
ies have demonstrated successful bone formation using direct injections of
osteogenic plasmid into either orthotopic or heterotopic sites.
Electroporation. The diffusion of extracellular DNA into a cell in vitro
and in vivo can be significantly increased by permeabilizing the cells mem
brane using short, high intense electric pulses. The technique essentially opens
small pores in the cells membrane, through which molecules can diffuse down
concentration gradients. When the pores spontaneously close, the DNA is sealed
within the cells cytoplasm, where it can be transported to the nucleus [58]. This
technique can increase the transduction rate over a 1,000-fold compared to
direct plasmid injection, and has been utilized to transduce liver, melanoma,
Helm/Anderson 18
dramroo
skin, and muscle cells [59, 60]. The ideal parameters for cellular transduction
appear to vary between tissues. In addition, only short-term gene expression has
been achieved. The utilization of this approach for the delivery of osteogenic
genes has yet to be defined.
Gene Gun. Another interesting technology which is currently under investi
gation for transducing cells with foreign DNA is the gene gun. The technique
involves the coating of gold particles with plasmid DNA, which are subsequently
bombarded into the tissue of interest [61]. Under optimal conditions, the gene gun
can be utilized to transduce 1020% of the cells at the treatment site. Although
gene expression of up to 60 days has been achieved, the depth of tissue penetra
tion is limited to 0.5 mm [62]. In addition, low levels of gene expression are
generally achieved, which is problematic for BMP gene therapy, where relatively
high levels of local BMP expression are required for tissue induction.
Liposomes. Liposomes are commonly used to deliver DNA to cells in
vitro [63]. Cationic derivatives of diacylglycerol and cholesterol, lipid deriva
tives of polyamines, and quaternary ammonium detergents are typically used
to form the cationic lipid-DNA complexes. The cationic-lipid compounds serve
to decrease the negative changes of the DNA plasmids and facilitate entrance
of the plasmids through the cell membrane. Liposome preparations also
contain neutral or helper lipids, including cholesterol or dioleoylphos
phatidylethanolamine, to improve DNA release from the endosome into the
cytoplasm [64]. Liposomes can transduce a wide variety of cells and tissues,
including vascular endothelium, lung, brain, and skin [65, 66]. The attachment
of cell-specific antibodies to the liposomal membrane may improve tissue
specificity of this transduction technique. Intense research efforts are currently
directed at improving liposome production and delivery, which may render
these vectors ideal for BMP gene delivery in the near future.
Polymer-DNA Complexes. High-molecular-weight cationic polymers, such
as poly-L-lysine, poly-L-ornithine, polyethylenimine, and chitosan, can improve
DNA delivery to cells via nonspecific absorptive uptake [67, 68]. Various syn
thetic polymers can also be utilized to improve cellular transduction rates and
can be designed to be biodegradable, thermosensitive, and biocompatible [69].
Polymers can also be constructed with targeting ligands, such as antibodies,
transferrin, and asialoglycoprotein to improve tissue specificity. Additional
modifications to these molecules can also be made to improve cellular uptake
and cytoplasmic trafficking of the therapeutic gene.
Helm/Anderson 20
dramroo
Fig. 1. Diagram showing mechanisms
of bone formation using direct, percuta
neous injection of an adenoviral vector con
taining the BMP-9 gene. Expression of
BMP-9 by the transduced cells leads to
migration, proliferation, and differentiation
of MSCs, ultimately leading to successful
osteogenesis.
Helm/Anderson 22
dramroo
significant bone formation in the paraspinal region following percutaneous
injection. The fusion mass integrated completely with the adjacent host spine,
similar to the direct BMP adenoviral vector treatment sites, without evidence of
posttreatment neural compression (unpubl. data).
In another set of interesting studies, Boden et al. [84, 85] have reported a
novel ex vivo gene therapy technique which utilizes the insertion of the osteogenic
LMP-1 gene into allogenic bone marrow cells. These investigators demonstrated
significant bone formation by the transduced cells in the paraspinal region of
rodents, in spite of relatively low transduction rates. LMP-1 gene therapy is
unique in that it is thought to induce the secretion of a variety of osteogenic
growth factors, which in turn stimulate bone formation.
These ex vivo techniques have the advantage of not only expressing
osteogenic morphogens, but also supplying the treated region with bone pre
cursor cells, which may be of limited supply at the treatment site. For example,
it is unclear whether pluripotent stem cells are uniformly present throughout the
body in the adult human, which could make direct BMP or BMP gene therapy
treatments ineffective. Also, the number of MSCs may decrease with age,
which might decrease the physiologic activity of BMPs. The introduction of
stem cells, which are genetically modified to secrete bone morphogens, is,
therefore, a compelling approach. The harvest and expansion of autologous
stem cells for widespread human use may be hampered by high costs, cellular
contamination, and other technical difficulties. Therefore, other approaches
such as the genetic modification of traditional bone grafts (which contain
cellular precursors such as stem cells and osteoblasts) at the time of surgery
may be a more reasonable near-term approach.
Recent studies have clearly demonstrated the potential utility of MSCs and
BMP gene therapy for the promotion of bone formation for spinal applications.
However, the field of molecular spine surgery is certainly in its infancy. Many
of the techniques are under continuing development and may require refine
ment prior to clinical application. The establishment of an allogenic or xeno
geneic source of stem cells, which could be modified to attenuate potential host
immune responses, would have significant advantages compared to autologous
cells for clinical application. Various groups are currently studying the use of
genetically modified porcine cells, which are genetically altered to decrease
their expression of foreign antigens. In addition, ex vivo gene therapy approaches
are currently being developed to induce local immunosuppression around the
transplanted cells. The efficacy of BMP gene therapy might also be improved
vector I vector II
Muscle
BMP I cell
homodimers BMP I/II
heterodimers BMP II
homodimers
Acknowledgment
This work was supported by an NIH grant (1 RO1 AR/AI4648801A2) and Medtronic-
Sofamor Danek; we thank Mona Banton for her editorial support.
Helm/Anderson 24
dramroo
References
1 Bruder SP, Kurth AA, Shea M, Hayes WC, Jaiswal N, Kadiyala S: Bone regeneration by implantation
of purified, culture-expanded human mesenchymal stem cells. J Orthop Res 1998;16:155162.
2 Bruder SP, Kraus KH, Goldberg VM, Kadiyala S: The effect of implants loaded with autologous
mesenchymal stem cells on the healing of canine segmental bone defects. J Bone Joint Surg Am
1998;80:985996.
3 Quarto R, Mastrogiacomo M, Cancedda R, Kutepov SM, Mukhachev V, Lavroukov A, Kon E,
Marcacci M: Repair of large bone defects with the use of autologous bone marrow stromal cells.
N Engl J Med 2001;344:385386.
4 Celeste AJ, Iannazzi JA, Taylor RC, Hewick RM, Rosen V, Wang EA, Wozney JM: Identification
of transforming growth factor beta family members present in bone-inductive protein purified
from bovine bone. Proc Natl Acad Sci USA 1990;87:98439847.
5 Sampath TK, Reddi AH: Homology of bone-inductive proteins from human, monkey, bovine, and
rat extracellular matrix. Proc Natl Acad Sci USA 1983;80:65916595.
6 Sampath TK, Nathanson MA, Reddi AH: In vitro transformation of mesenchymal cells derived
from embryonic muscle into cartilage in response to extracellular matrix components of bone.
Proc Natl Acad Sci USA 1984;81:34193423.
7 Wozney JM, Rosen V, Celeste AJ, Mitsock LM, Whitters MJ, Kriz RW, Hewick RM, Wang EA:
Novel regulators of bone formation: Molecular clones and activities. Science 1988;242:15281534.
8 Urist MR: Bone: Formation by autoinduction. Science 1965;150:893899.
9 Urist MR, Silverman BF, Buring K, Dubuc FL, Rosenberg JM: The bone induction principle. Clin
Orthop 1967;53:243283.
10 Urist MR, Dowell TA, Hay PH, Strates BS: Inductive substrates for bone formation. Clin Orthop
1968;59:5996.
11 Urist MR: A morphogenetic matrix for differentiation of bone tissue. Calcif Tissue Res 1970
(suppl):98101.
12 Urist MR, Strates BS: Bone morphogenetic protein. J Dent Res 1971;50:13921406.
13 Urist MR, Sato K, Brownell AG, Malinin TI, Lietze A, Huo YK, Prolo DJ, Oklund S, Finerman GA,
DeLange RJ: Human bone morphogenetic protein (hBMP). Proc Soc Exp Biol Med 1983;
173:194199.
14 Yamaguchi A, Katagiri T, Ikeda T, Wozney JM, Rosen V, Wang EA, Kahn AJ, Suda T, Yoshiki S:
Recombinant human bone morphogenetic protein-2 stimulates osteoblastic maturation and
inhibits myogenic differentiation in vitro. J Cell Biol 1991;113:681687.
15 Reddi AH, Wientroub S, Muthukumaran N: Biologic principles of bone induction. Orthop Clin
North Am 1987;18:207212.
16 Helm GA, Li JZ, Alden TD, Hudson SB, Beres EJ, Cunningham M, Mikkelsen MM, Pittman DD,
Kerns KM, Kallmes DF: A light and electron microscopic study of ectopic tendon and ligament
formation induced by bone morphogenetic protein-13 adenoviral gene therapy. J Neurosurg 2001;
95:298301.
17 Aspenberg P, Forslund C: Enhanced tendon healing with GDF 5 and 6. Acta Orthop Scand 1999;
70:5154.
18 Chang SC, Hoang B, Thomas JT, Vukicevic S, Luyten FP, Ryba NJ, Kozak CA, Reddi AH,
Moos M Jr: Cartilage-derived morphogenetic proteins. New members of the transforming growth
factor-beta superfamily predominantly expressed in long bones during human embryonic develop
ment. J Biol Chem 1994;269:2822728234.
19 Chen P, Carrington JL, Hammonds RG, Reddi AH: Stimulation of chondrogenesis in limb bud
mesoderm cells by recombinant human bone morphogenetic protein 2B (BMP-2B) and modula
tion by transforming growth factor beta 1 and beta 2. Exp Cell Res 1991;195:509515.
20 Evans CHPD, Robbins PDP: Genetically augmented tissue engineering of the musculoskeletal
system. Clin Orthop 1999;367S:S410S418.
21 Grande DAP, Breitbart ASMD, Mason JP, Paulino CMD, Laser JBS, Schwartz REMD: Cartilage
tissue engineering: Current limitations and solutions. Clin Orthop 1999;367S:S176S185.
22 Kapur SP, Reddi AH: Chondrogenic potential of mesenchymal cells elicited by bone matrix in
vitro. Differentiation 1986;32:252259.
Helm/Anderson 26
dramroo
48 Fisher KJ, Jooss K, Alston J, Yang Y, Haecker SE, High K, Pathak R, Raper SE, Wilson JM:
Recombinant adeno-associated virus for muscle directed gene therapy. Nat Med 1997;3:
306312.
49 Culver KW: Gene therapy for malignant neoplasms of the CNS. Bone Marrow Transplant 1996;
18(suppl 3):S6S9.
50 Coffin RS, Howard MK, Cumming DV, Dollery CM, McEwan J, Yellon DM, Marber MS,
MacLean AR, Brown SM, Latchman DS: Gene delivery to the heart in vivo and to cardiac
myocytes and vascular smooth muscle cells in vitro using herpes virus vectors. Gene Ther 1996;3:
560566.
51 Wolff JA: Direct gene transfer into mouse muscle in vivo. Science 1990;247:14651468.
52 Nomura T: Gene expression and antitumor effects following direct interferon (IFN)-gamma gene
transfer with naked plasmid DNA and DC-chol liposome complexes in mice. Gene Ther 1999;6:
121129.
53 Ardehali A: Direct gene transfer into donor hearts at the time of harvest. J Thorac Cardiovasc Surg
1995;109:716720.
54 Schwartz B: Gene transfer by naked DNA into adult mouse brain. Protein Sci 1996;5:488494.
55 Sikes ML: In vivo gene transfer into rabbit thyroid follicular cells by direct DNA injection. Hum
Gene Ther 1994;5:837844.
56 Davis HL: Direct gene transfer into skeletal muscle in vivo: Factors affecting efficiency of trans
fer and stability of expression. Hum Gene Ther 1993;4:151159.
57 Zhang G: High levels of foreign gene expression in hepatocytes after tail vein injections of naked
plasmid DNA. Hum Gene Ther 1999;10:17351737.
58 Mir LM: Introduction of definite amounts of nonpermeant molecules into living cells after elec
tropermeabilization: Direct access to the cytosol. Exp Cell Res 1988;175:1525.
59 Titomirov AV: In vivo electroporation and stable transformation of skin cells of newborn mice by
plasmid DNA. Biochim Biophys Acta 1991;1088:131134.
60 Aihara H, Miyazaki J: Gene transfer into muscle by electroporation in vivo. Nat Biotechnol 1998;
16:867870.
61 Yang NS: In vivo and in vitro gene transfer to mammalian somatic cells by particle bombardment.
Proc Natl Acad Sci USA 1990;87:95689572.
62 Zelenin AV: Bacterial beta-galactosidase and human dystrophin genes are expressed in mouse
skeletal muscle fibers after ballistic transfection. FEBS Lett 1997;414:319322.
63 Felgner PL: Lipofection: A highly efficient, lipid-mediated DNA-transfection procedure. Proc
Natl Acad Sci USA 1987;84:74137417.
64 Farhood H: The role of dioleoyl phosphatidylethanolamine in cationic liposome mediated gene
transfer. Biochim Biophys Acta 1995;1235:289295.
65 Ono T: Plasmid DNAs directly injected into mouse brain with lipofectin can be incorporated and
expressed by brain cells. Neurosci Lett 1990;117:259263.
66 Raz E: Intradermal gene immunization: The possible role of DNA uptake in the induction of
cellular immunity to viruses. Proc Natl Acad Sci USA 1994;91:95199523.
67 Nishikawa M: Nonviral vectors in the new millennium: Delivery barriers in gene transfer. Hum
Gene Ther 2001;12:861870.
68 Boussif O: A versatile vector for gene and oligonucleotide transfer into cells in culture and in vivo:
Polyethylenimine. Proc Natl Acad Sci USA 1995;92:72977301.
69 Maheshwari A: Soluble biodegradable polymer-based cytokine gene delivery for cancer treatment.
Mol Ther 2000;2:121130.
70 Varady P, Li JZ, Cunningham M, Beres EJ, Das S, Engh J, Alden TD, Pittman DD, Kerns KM,
Kallmes DF, Helm GA: Morphologic analysis of BMP-9 gene therapy-induced osteogenesis. Hum
Gene Ther 2001;12:697710.
71 Alden TD, Pittman DD, Beres EJ, Hankins GR, Kallmes DF, Wisotsky BM, Kerns KM, Helm GA:
Percutaneous spinal fusion using bone morphogenetic protein-2 gene therapy. J Neurosurg 1999;
90:109114.
72 Helm GA, Alden TD, Beres EJ, Hudson SB, Das S, Engh JA, Pittman DD, Kerns KM, Kallmes DF:
Use of bone morphogenetic protein-9 gene therapy to induce spinal arthrodesis in the rodent.
J Neurosurg 2000;92:191196.
82 Mason JM, Breitbart AS, Barcia M, Porti D, Pergolizzi RG, Grande DA: Cartilage and bone regen
eration using gene-enhanced tissue engineering. Clin Orthop 2000;379(suppl):S171S178.
83 Moutsatsos IK, Turgeman G, Zhou S, Kurkalli BG, Pelled G, Tzur L, Kelley P, Stumm N, Mi S,
Muller R, Zilberman Y, Gazit D: Exogenously regulated stem cell-mediated gene therapy for bone
regeneration. Mol Ther 2001;3:449461.
84 Boden SD, Titus L, Hair G, Liu Y, Viggeswarapu M, Nanes MS, Baranowski C: Lumbar spine
fusion by local gene therapy with a cDNA encoding a novel osteoinductive protein (LMP-1).
Spine 1998;23:24862492.
85 Boden SD, Liu Y, Hair GA, Helms JA, Hu D, Racine M, Nanes MS, Titus L: LMP-1, a LIM-
domain protein, mediates BMP-6 effects on bone formation. Endocrinology 1998;139:
51255134.
Tel. 1 434 924 1642, Fax 1 434 924 2994, E-Mail [email protected]
Helm/Anderson 28
dramroo
Haid RW Jr, Subach BR, Rodts GE Jr (eds): Advances in Spinal Stabilization.
Bone Substitutes
Karin R. Swartz, Gregory R. Trost
University of Wisconsin-Madison, Madison, Wisc., USA
There has long been a need to minimize the morbidity associated with
spinal fusions. Bone substitutes are the most recent focus of this process, in an
attempt to minimize the morbidities of donor site harvesting without compro
mising fusion. Autograft bone, consisting primarily of cancellous and some cor
tical bone, is the current standard for spinal fusion constructs. However,
harvesting autograft usually requires a second incision and involves a risk of
associated morbidities, such as infection, blood loss, hematoma formation, neu
rologic and vascular damage, pain, joint destabilization, and fractures.
Furthermore there is a limit to the size, shape, and volumes of harvested auto
graft. Methods for strengthening the spine and improving nonunion/delayed
healing rates are actively being pursued.
The ideal graft should be biocompatible, osteoinductive, and resorbable.
This allows for incorporation with the surrounding tissues, including vascular
ization [1, 2]. An ideal graft should be malleable, but once in vivo, should not
flow out of the graft bed [3]. It must restore the spine to its functional state [2]
with pain relief [4], allowing for decreased disability. Furthermore, an ideal
graft must be sterile, to abolish the risk of disease transmission. Finally, it
should be easy to use and cost-effective.
Physiology
dramroo
remodeling. Bone remodeling, a balance between bone formation (osteoblastic)
and bone resorption (osteoclastic) functions, is important for skeletal growth as
well as maintenance of normal bone structure. Various growth factors (GFs)
have been implicated in the function of maintaining/healing bone, including
transforming growth factor- (TGF-), platelet-derived growth factor, insulin-
like growth factors, fibroblast growth factors, and bone morphogenetic proteins
(BMPs) [3].
Osteoinduction involves active recruitment of mesenchymal stem cells
and facilitation of their differentiation along the osteoblastic lineage [2].
Osteoinduction more commonly occurs in cancellous more so than cortical
bone, and appears to be under the control of BMPs, as opposed to the other
GFs, which are not osteoinductive. Osteoconduction, which involves the ingrowth
of cells to create and support a stable bony environment, is likewise achieved
more readily through cancellous than cortical bone.
Bone Allograft
Tissue Engineering
Swartz/Trost 30
dramroo
Table 1. Commercially available substitutes [adapted from 2]
Carriers
Carrier substances can be divided into four major categories: inorganic
materials (bioglasses and ceramics), synthetic polymers (especially poly
methylmethacrylate), natural polymers (primarily collagen), and composites
(various) (table 1) [3]. Collagen combined with hydroxyapatite is one of the
most widely used first-generation composite carriers, which is both flexible and
able to bond directly with bone [3]. As scaffolds, carriers must act as permis
sive environments for osteoconduction to be successful [3] (table 2).
Hyaff-11
Hyaff-11 is a new semisynthetic biopolymer that can be fabricated into
porous scaffolds for tissue reconstruction. It is a benzyl ester derivative of the poly
saccharide hyaluronic acid, a natural component of the ECM. Hyaluronic acid
plays a role in proteoglycan organization, cell differentiation, and wound healing.
It has well-established biocompatibility, and is biodegradable in 812 weeks in
vivo [6]. In a study by Kim and Valenti [6], Hyaff-11 was used as scaffolding for
the delivery of rhBMP-2, and showed low constitutive levels of release of BMP-2,
with good retention of the morphogenetic protein at the site, with success based on
the resultant increased expression of osteoblasts with bone formation.
Bone Substitutes 31
dramroo
Table 2. Pros and cons of carrier substances [adapted from 3]
Pros Similar structureto bone Reproducible manufacture Excellent biocompatibility Benefits from
Resorbable or Readily tailored May have natural affinity different materials
nonresorbable Controlled release for GFs exploited
Affinity for BMPs Ease of sterilization
Cons Brittle/difficult Breakdown products Pathogen transmission Complex manufacture
to mold might be inflammatory Sterilization
May be exothermic Solvents or cross-linkers Potential immunogenicity
might denature proteins
Nonphysiologic material
Examples Porous coralline HA Poly (-hydroxy acid) Fibrin glue Collagen-TCP
B-tricalcium Polypropylene fumarate Collagen (type I) Collagen-HA
phosphates (B-TCP) Polyanhydrides Chitosan TCP-cellulose
Hyaluronic acid Polyphosphazenes Hyaluronic acid
Calcium phosphate Polozamers Gelatin
cements DBM
Metals
Calcium sulfates
PLA-DX-PEG
Saito et al. [5] developed a biodegradable synthetic polymer to deliver
BMP-2. PLA-DX-PEG (poly-D,L-lactic acid-p-dioxanone-polyethylene
glycol) is available as a block copolymer that is biocompatible and biodegrad
able. It offers an alternative to bone banking with no disease transmission, no
evidence of immunoreaction or foreign body reaction, and is more effective
than collagen-BMP-2 systems in regard to calcium content of formed ossi
cles. Also, it swells a little when in contact with water and thus fills the dead
space at the bone-implant interface and provides a layer of scaffolding for
new bone [5].
Polymethylmethacrylate
Polymethylmethacrylate is the only available cement with reports of clinical
application and experience for vertebroplasty in the treatment of osteoporosis [1].
Polyetheretherketone
Polyetheretherketone (PEEK) is a radiolucent, biocompatible synthetic
polymer that purports similar stiffness to cortical bone. It is a polyaromatic
Swartz/Trost 32
dramroo
semicrystalline thermoplastic which is available as a cage (Stryker Solis) or
in a pellet form for injection molding or machined cage (Invibio PEEK
OPTIMA). When in cage form, it can be packed with either auto- or allograft
to facilitate fusion.
Poly(L-Lactic Acid)
Poly(L-lactic acid) cages are radiolucent bioabsorbable cages that
demonstrate higher elasticity and thus less stiffness than metal cages. They have
been proven mechanically sufficient and resorb after providing support for an
average of 6 months [7].
Demineralized bone matrix products (ex: Osteofil) are other osteoinduc
tive graft substitutes. No current objective clinical data [8] is available.
Delivery Systems
Techniques for application of GFs are many, with the most commonly
cited described next: (1) delivery of DNA encoding a GF or in vivo gene
therapy, (2) delivery of a cell to produce the GF or ex vivo gene therapy also
called cell therapy, and (3) delivery of the protein itself via some carrier
matrix [3].
The latter of these has advanced the furthest, with ongoing attempts to
discover optimal carriers for GFs. These carriers would allow controlled release
(appropriate kinetics) with therapeutic dosing and would act as sturdy scaffolds
[3], thus encouraging cells to migrate and differentiate (osteoconduction and
osteoinduction), as well as allow ingrowth of blood vessels, passage of nutri
ents, and expulsion of waste products [3]. Degradation and breakdown of the
carrier matrix should either be inert or beneficial to healing, and should be
synchronized with the rate of bone regeneration: too slow, and bone growth/
remodeling is retarded and carries a risk of encapsulation, and too fast, and the
definition of optimal shape may be lost [3].
Gene therapy, in its most generic terms, can be divided into in vivo or
ex vivo techniques to deliver a gene sequence for the osteoinductive factor (rather
than the factor itself) [9]. Both involve insertion of foreign cDNA directly into
a host (in vivo) or into donor cells (ex vivo) via a vector, ultimately forming
cells whose primary purpose is to produce a desired GF [3]. In the in vivo
model, also known as in situ therapy, a vector is directly introduced into host
cells inside the body, the vector acting as the carrier. In the ex vivo model, also
known as cell therapy, the cells can either be harvested from the patient or
another donor; that cell then becomes the carrier for the secreted GF (using
tissue culture expansion and gene transduction), and then is delivered into
the host [3, 10]. The success of gene therapy relies on accurate transduction,
transcription, translation, and expression (table 3).
Bone Substitutes 33
dramroo
Table 3. Pros and cons of gene therapy techniques
Pros Cons
Growth Factors
The current trend in osteoinductive bone graft substitutes for minimally
invasive spine fusions includes providing GF cytokines in addition to the scaf
folding of the carriers. Categories of factors used in these substitutes include
purified bone GFs, recombinant bone GFs, and gene therapy-delivered GFs.
The working current hypothesis is that a burst followed by sustained factor
release is ideal, allowing for cellular migration to the area, with eventual com
mitment to osteoblastic lineages with propagation of cellular numbers [3].
An example of a GF invested as an osteoinductive bone graft is BMP.
Swartz/Trost 34
dramroo
Sustained production of high levels of activated BMP-2 using recombinant
adenovirus type 5 (Ad5BMP-2) has been achieved by Olmsted et al. [14]. In their
research, they were able to elicit BMP synthesis upon infection even by non
osteoprogenitor cells, which was 3-fold more active than equivalent concentrations
of rhBMP-2 [14].
The issue of physical containment of BMP still needs to be optimized, such
that it remains in place, without causing unwanted bone growth that could
potentially cause neurovascular compromise.
Preclinical Data
Animal models, especially small animals, have shown success with treat
ment of fractures and segmental defects [3]; Murata et al. [27] showed successful
rapid bone growth from an onlay over bone without periosteum, using rhBMP-2
and bioabsorbable atelocollagen in rats. Ripamonti et al. [28] used BMP-7
(OP-1) to grow bone over a cranial defect in baboons. Boden [29] developed a
rabbit model to characterize the healing process, and sequenced a novel cDNA
encoding for LMP-1 (LIM-mineralizing protein-1, an intracellular protein which
induces osteoblastic differentiation); when implanted locally in the bone marrow
transfected with LMP-1 cDNA, he reported 100% fusion. Majumdar et al. [11,
30] isolated multipotential mesenchymal cells from the bone marrow and cul
tured them in the presence of TGF-3 and recombinant human BMPs (rhBMP-2
and rhBMP-9) causing chondrogenic differentiation, a technique that could allow
for delivery of chondrogenic GFs to the site of articular cartilage repair. Noshi et
al. [16] further advanced the bone-forming capability of a composite using mar
row mesenchymal stem cells and porous hydroxyapatite by adding rhBMP-2 to
the composite, which resulted in accelerated bone formation.
Clinical Trials
Boden et al. [20] were the first to demonstrate the clinical efficacy of
rhBMP-2 for single-level spinal arthrodesis, comparing tapered titanium fusion
cages packed with either rhBMP-2 (1.5 mg/ml) soaked onto bovine collagen
sponge or with morselized iliac autograft. Success was based on shorter hospi
tal stays, shorter operative time, less blood loss, and improved fusion in the
cage-BMP construct.
Sandhu [8] performed anterior lumbar interbody fusions using combined
threaded titanium cages filled with autograft and compared with cages filled
with rhBMP-2, and found the cages filled with rhBMP-2 had better outcomes,
including high fusion rates, shorter operative time, and shorter hospital stays.
Bone Substitutes 35
dramroo
Table 4. Comparisons of autograft, allograft, and substitutes
Autograft
Cancellous No
Cortical
Allograft
Cancellous
Frozen No No
Freeze-dry No No
Cortical
Frozen No No
Freeze-dry No No
Substitutes
OrthoBlast No No 10 cm3: USD 850/
DynaGraft No No 5 cm3 USD 470
ProOsteon 500R ? No No 10 cm3: USD 850/
Grafton No No 5 cm3 USD 470
OSTEOSET No No No 10 cm3: USD 1,150
AlloMatrix No No 6 strips: USD 1,109/
Collagraft No No 3 strips: USD 683
Vitoss No No No 10 cm3: USD 525
Other Issues
Different anatomical sites may require different substitutes. Special con
sideration must be given to variables of the involved kinetics with different
locations, the effects of medications, the impact of disease processes, and of
aging on the efficacy of function [2, 3, 6].
Objective measures determining utility of any bone-stabilizing product must
certainly include cost containment issues centered around operating room func
tions, including time required for the procedure, duration of needed anesthesia,
supplies used/needed, and length of stay in recovery and in hospital (table 4).
Swartz/Trost 36
dramroo
As always, success of fusion depends on many factors, but is maximized
by the basic tenets of properly prepared sites, exposed cancellous bone,
mechanical loading and stability.
References
Bone Substitutes 37
dramroo
21 Subach BR, Haid RW, Rodts GE, Kaiser MG: Bone morphogenetic protein in spinal fusion:
Overview and clinical update. Neurosurg Focus 2001;10/4:16.
22 Sanders EJ, Parker E: Ablation of axial structures activates apoptotic pathways in somite cells of
the chick embryo. Anat Embryol 2001;204:389398.
23 Miller AF, Harvey SA, Thies RS, Olson MS: Bone morphogenetic protein-9. An autocrine/
paracrine cytokine in the liver. J Biol Chem 2000;275:1793717945.
24 Lopez-Coviella I, Berse B, Krauss R, Thies RS, Blusztajn JK: Induction and maintenance of the
neuronal cholinergic phenotype in the CNS by BMP-9. Science 2000;289:313316.
25 Jordan J, Bottner M, Schluesener HJ, Unsicker K, Krieglstein K: Bone morphogenetic proteins:
Neurotrophic roles for midbrain dopaminergic neurons and implications of astroglial cells. Eur J
Neurosci 1997;9:16991709.
26 De Caestecker M, Meyrick B: Bone morphogenetic proteins, genetics, and the pathophysiology of
primary pulmonary hypertension. Respir Res 2001;2/4:193197.
27 Murata M, Maki F, Sato D, Shibata T, Arisue M: Bone augmentation by onlay implant using
recombinant human BMP-2 and collagen on adult rat skull without periosteum. Clin Oral Impl
Res 2000;11:289295.
28 Ripamonti U, van den Heever B, Sampath TK, Tucker MM, Rueger DC, Redoli AH: Complete
regeneration of bone in the baboon by recombinant human osteogenic protein-1 (hOP-1, bone
morphogenetic protein-7). Growth Factors 1996;13:273289.
29 Boden SD: Biology of lumbar spine fusion and use of bone graft substitutes: Present, future, and
next generation. Tissue Eng 2000;6:383399.
30 Majumdar MK, Banks V, Peluso DP, Morris EA: Isolation, characterization, and chondrogenic
potential of human bone marrow-derived multipotential stromal cells. J Cell Physiol 2000;185:
98106.
Gregory R. Trost, MD
University of Wisconsin-Madison
Swartz/Trost 38
dramroo
Haid RW Jr, Subach BR, Rodts GE Jr (eds): Advances in Spinal Stabilization.
Spinal Stabilization
dramroo
cautioned to review the FDA-approved indications for the use of any of the
described products prior to the experimental or therapeutic use of any of the
products described.
Autograft bone remains the gold standard for spinal fusion procedures,
especially lumbar posterolateral fusion. Autograft bone is osteogenic, in that it
contains the cellular components responsible for new bone formation.
Autograft is osteoinductive, in that it contains diffusible proteins which induce
neighboring cells to produce bone. Autograft is also osteoconductive, in that it
has a structure which allows for the migration of osteogenic cells which can
then form new bone [2]. Depending upon the size, shape, and source of the
autograft, mechanical strength may be negligible (cancellous) or substantial
(tricortical iliac crest, fibula, rib). Drawbacks to the use of autograft include
harvest site morbidity as well as limited availability. The use of allograft bone
avoids the problem of graft site morbidity, and allograft humeral, femoral, and
patellar grafts are available for use as large load-bearing struts. Allograft bone
is osteoconductive, and in some preparations may be somewhat osteoinductive
(such as in demineralized bone matrix). Unfortunately, allograft bone is not
always readily available. Allograft is expensive to preshape into readily used
sizes. Finally, some patients may refuse the use of allograft for religious reasons
or because of fear of infection.
Although there are many alternatively prepared allograft products
(Grafton, Dynagraft, Osteofil) and xenograft products (Collagraft, True
Bone Ceramics) available for use which may extend the utility of allograft
use, the manufacture of these products still requires the use of processed donor
(human or animal) bone. In some cases, the extensive preparation of these
products has resulted in unexpected toxicity. For example, Botsman et al. [3]
and Wang et al. [4] recently presented evidence to suggest that the glycerol car
rier in Grafton (Osteotech, Eatontown, N.J., USA) may be toxic in large doses.
This discussion will center on synthetic resorbable bone substitutes.
The use of synthetic bone graft material would negate the risks of harvest
site morbidity, disease transmission, and limited donor availability. The ability
to machine the material would allow for the creation of multiple shapes and
sizes that could be used as off-the-shelf bone substitutes. Substantial cost sav
ings may be realized with reasonably priced implants if the costs of autograft
harvest (estimated to be USD 1,5005,000 for iliac crest [5, 6]) and allograft
harvest and preparation (machined allograft bone wedge approximately
USD 3,000 per level, allograft femoral ring USD 1,2002,400 per level;
Resnick/Alexander/Welch 40
dramroo
source: University of Wisconsin operating room) are avoided. Ideally, these
synthetic bone grafts would be totally absorbed by the body and replaced by
native bone.
Calcium sulfate (plaster of Paris) has been used for bone defect repair
since 1892 [7, 8]. Peltier and Jones [9] used calcium sulfate pellets to fill uni
cameral bone cysts in 26 patients with excellent results, and Coetzee [10] used
similar pellets to treat osseous defects in the skull and facial bones in 110
patients. Recently, Kelly et al. [7] reported the use of Osteoset (Wright Medical
Technology, Tenn., USA) a highly processed form of calcium sulfate for repair
of bone defects in a series of 109 patients with various bone lesions. Osteoset
was used as a bone graft substitute if the surgeon recommended the use of
morsellized graft, the bone void was not intrinsic to the stability of the struc
ture, and the void shape could accommodate the calcium sulfate pellets. Overall
results were excellent, with 100% pellet resorption and 94% new bone growth
(radiographic criteria) noted at 1 year [7]. No spinal fusions were performed
during the study, and other materials were used in addition to the pellets in 65%
of cases. Hadjipavlou et al. [11] recently reported excellent results with calcium
sulfate-filled titanium cages in an interbody fusion model in adult sheep. These
authors obtained roughly equivalent results with cages filled with either autograft
iliac crest or with calcium sulfate. There are at present, however, no published
reports of the use of calcium sulfate for human spinal fusion.
Processed coralline grafts, including hydroxyapatite, have been used exten
sively for the repair of bone defects. Additionally, these products have been used
for spine surgery with a number of different applications. Hydroxyapatite is a
poorly crystalline calcium phosphate compound which is similar in mineral
composition to bone [6]. Calcium phosphate and hydroxyapatite are osteocon
ductive, if the porosity, pore size, and degree of pore interconnectivity are
optimized [6]. Substantial research has established that the ideal pore size is
between 100 and 500 m [12]. Calcium hydroxyapatite is most commonly
formed through processing of coral, which contains calcium phosphate and
calcium carbonate in the form of aragonite. Several natural corals, particularly
Porites and Goniopora, have pore sizes and pore interconnectivity which allow
for osteoconduction. These corals have been harvested, cleansed, and then used
as graft material (Biocoral Inoteb, France), particularly in dental surgery [13].
These corals may also be chemically treated via the replamineform process.
This process results in the conversion of aragonite to hydroxyapatite without
changing the three-dimensional structure of the coral [6]. ProOsteon 200R,
500R, and Interpore porous hydroxyapatite (Interpore Cross International,
Calif., USA) are produced in this fashion. The numbers 200R and 500R refer to
the nominal pore diameter of the crystalline structure, either 200 or 500 m.
The mechanical properties of coralline hydroxyapatite grafts are more similar
Resnick/Alexander/Welch 42
dramroo
It is virtually identical to bone in terms of its mineral composition, and no
reports of systemic toxicity exist. A comparative study by Emery et al. [20]
demonstrated that the use of tricalcium phosphate (pore size 400 m) resulted
in superior histological results compared to hydroxyapatite or calcium carbon
ate in a canine interbody fusion model. Toth et al. [21] studied the use of
different -tricalcium phosphate/hydroxyapatite preparations in a goat cervical
interbody fusion model and found that -tricalcium phosphate performed as
well or better than autograft at 3 and 6 months following fusion (radiographic,
histological, dual-energy x-ray absorptiometry, and biomechanical testing).
There was a definite increase in the bony union rate at 3 months with increas
ing porosity (0% union rate for autograft and 30% porous ceramic, 67% for
50% porous ceramic, and 83% for 70% porous ceramic). Delecrin et al. [1]
used a similar compound (Triosite Zimmer, France) in a study of 58 patients
undergoing surgery for scoliosis. In a prospective randomized study, these
authors found that patients who received the ceramic graft had less blood loss
and had no graft site complications. The authors noted that half of the autograft
group experienced pain at the donor site 6 months following surgery. There
were no significant differences between autograft and ceramic groups in terms
of radiographic appearance or functional outcome at a minimum follow-up of
24 months (mean follow-up 48 months) [1].
A pure -tricalcium phosphate synthetic bone product has been recently
introduced (Vitoss, Orthovita, Pa., USA). Vitoss has a unique crystalline
structure, imparted by the manufacturing process, which increases its porosity
significantly. The porosity of Vitoss is between 88 and 92%, compared to an
approximate 55% porosity of hydroxyapatite-calcium carbonate. The increased
porosity of this product allows for the rapid penetration of blood and blood
products as well as for the migration of osteoblasts. Animal experiments using
a humeral defect model have confirmed that the tricalcium phosphate is rapidly
and nearly completely replaced by native bone in a matter of weeks (fig. 1, 2).
The formation of bone in the humeral model is more rapid and more complete
than that seen with coralline hydroxyapatite bone substitutes (fig. 1). In time, the
graft is completely resorbed and replaced by new bone. When combined with
autogenous bone marrow, the osteoinductive properties of the tricalcium phos
phate are superior to demineralized bone matrix in a rat Urist pouch test [22].
A similar -tricalcium phosphate compound has been developed (but is not yet
FDA approved) that has biomechanical properties similar to cortical bone, can
be machined and shaped easily, and can even be delivered in a semiliquid or
putty form (Cortoss, Orthovita, Pa., USA).
Several other types of compounds have been used as synthetic bone substi
tutes. Madawi et al. [23] studied a bioactive osteoconductive polymer made of
methyl methacrylate, calcium gluconate, and polyamide fibers. These authors
Volume (%)
24
18
12
0
0 13 26 39 52
Time (weeks)
Fig. 1. Rapid absorption of Vitoss with regrowth of new bone within the graft.
a b
Fig. 2. Vitoss tricalcium phosphate bone substitute in a canine humeral defect model.
The implant is almost completely resorbed at 6 weeks postimplant (a) and is indistinguish
able from normal bone radiographically and histologically at 12 weeks (b).
noted favorable clinical results with this compound in trial of cervical interbody
fusion; however, the graft never radiographically incorporated into native bone.
Schulte et al. [24] used a bioglass-polyurethane composite to replace vertebral
bodies following corpectomy for metastatic lesions in 5 patients. All patients
also underwent titanium plate fixation. No instances of implant failure were
noted. Roessler et al. [25] reported sobering results in their clinical study of a
resorbable compound made up of polyethylene oxide and polybutylene tere
phthalate (Polyactive 70/30 HC Implants, The Netherlands) for reconstitution
of iliac crest bone graft harvest sites. Although this substance had shown very
promising results in multiple animal models, human trials failed to show a favor
able effect on clinical or radiographic outcome. This study serves as a reminder
that there is no substitute for properly designed human clinical trials for the
Resnick/Alexander/Welch 44
dramroo
development of bone graft substitutes. Differences in the healing capabilities
of the animal species, influences of patient age, and differences in the graft
environment all play a role in bone healing [25, 26].
CO2 H2O
Resnick/Alexander/Welch 46
dramroo
polymeric debris may exceed the tissue tolerance and transport potential of the
implantation site [27, 38]. This in turn can stimulate what is said to be a non
specific foreign-body reaction rather than a true inflammatory response [27, 38].
Thus, a large implant made of a fast-degrading polymer is likely to produce a
more pronounced inflammation than a small implant composed of a slow-
degrading polymer. PGA polymers have been associated with a higher rate of
tissue reaction, even including the formation of fibrous capsules, sterile cysts
and sinuses. On the other hand, pure polylactic acid (PLA) polymers have a
low or nonexistent rate of tissue reaction, while once again, copolymers are
intermediate [27, 38, 44].
Histological evaluation of these inflammatory sites has shown typical
nonspecific foreign-body reactions. Similar foreign-body reactions were found
on histological examination of implant sites of patients without clinical evi
dence of an inflammatory response [40]. These specimens were obtained upon
reoperation for fixation failure. No explanation is available for why some patients
have clinical signs of the foreign body reaction while others do not. Most stud
ies have shown the inflammatory response, when clinically present, to occur
several months after implantation. Bostman [40] postulates that this time to
occurrence of the reaction is reflective of the estimated degradation time of
PGA and PLLA/PGA implants which is 90120 days. Patients who have had
plates and screws made solely of PLLA, implanted for fixation of zygomatic
fractures, have shown inflammatory reactions from 3.3 to 5.7 years after surgery
[35]. These findings seem to correlate with degradation rates of PLLA, stated
in some studies to be from 2 to over 4 years [39].
PLA polymers and PLA-PGA copolymers are biocompatible with the dura
[4547]. PLA biocompatibility has also been specifically tested in reference to
neural tissue, including brain and spinal cord tissue as well as peripheral nerves.
No effect on neuronal cells, nonneuronal cells or axonal growth has been noted
[45, 48]. No significant toxicity, carcinogenicity, teratogenicity or mutagenesis
has been associated with either PLA or PGA [27, 38].
LactoSorb plates and screws became commercially available for cranio
facial applications in 1996. Most of the interest in bioresorbable plates for cranial
reconstruction has been in the pediatric patient population because of compli
cations with metallic implants related to bone growth. LactoSorb plates have
been used in neurosurgery for fixation of craniotomy flaps, repair of depressed
skull fractures and for repair of craniosynostosis [33, 4953]. Encouragingly, it
has been found that the dissolution and gradual loss of tensile strength of the
devices minimize growth restrictions as well as the potential for transcranial
migration [54]. In addition, good results have been obtained in both the pedi
atric and adult population when LactoSorb plates and screws were used for
cranial fixation and reconstruction.
Resnick/Alexander/Welch 48
dramroo
Fig. 4. Explanted LactoSorb plate. Histological examination of explanted LactoSorb
plate demonstates complete resorption of implant material 1 year following surgery (bone on
right, normal soft tissues on left) without evidence of persistent inflammatory reaction.
Implantation 100
6 months 90
9 months 70
12 months 50
18 months 0
implant disappears within 36 months [33, 51, 59]. Most studies of LactoSorb
plates show the entire implant to be 95% resorbed by 9 months and completely
resorbed by 1 year (fig. 4) [60].
MacroPore is characterized by a degradation time of 1836 months. The loss
of strength during degradation has been well characterized, and is predictable [61]
(table1). As noted above, however, the strength and degradation characteristics
of any specific MacroPore implant will be influenced by the manufacturing
processes, implant size and geometry, and characteristics of the implantation
site, among other factors. MacroPore can be formed into a wide variety of shapes,
and it can be stored and sterilized utilizing conventional techniques. In appro
priate shapes, MacroPore can be heated and shaped for conformation to the
actual site of implantation, and it will hold the desired shape once cooled with
out loss of structural integrity [MacroPore: pers. commun.].
Resnick/Alexander/Welch 50
dramroo
One such study examines the use of MacroPore devices in instrumented poste
rior lumbar interbody fusion constructs [62]. The devices are placed following
complete discectomy, along with morsellized autograft bone, and maintain the
disc space height during the early phase of bone healing. Preliminary results
show equivalent clinical outcomes to those obtained with the use of allograft
bone spacers. The devices produce no artifact on postoperative imaging, allow
ing better visualization of the maturing bone fusion [62].
Other products are being developed worldwide in order to expand the
applications of bioabsorbable products. Bostman et al. [40] used a biodegrad
able rod for internal fixation of extremity fractures and osteotomies. The com
position of the rods was either polyglycolide or a lactide-glycolide copolymer
(polyglactin). A small percentage of the 516 patients treated required reopera
tion for fixation failure (1.2%). The incidence of bacterial wound infections
was low (1.7%). The most significant complication was a foreign-body reaction
in 7.9% of the patients. The reaction caused a painful, reddened, fluctuant
swelling at the operative site 24 months after surgery. Godard et al. [69] have
investigated a bioresorbable implant for spinal arthrodesis, which is reported to
undergo ossification. Brunon et al. [70] have used a bioresorbable plate devel
oped from PLLA for anterior cervical interbody stabilization in 5 patients. The
development of bioabsorbable plates, screws, and rods for use in the spine is an
area of intense activity at the present time.
Conclusion
Absorbable bone substitutes and fixation devices are being developed for
spinal surgery. Advances in material technology may allow for the avoidance of
autograft harvest morbidity and allograft preparation costs and toxicities.
Resorbable implants may result in decreased morbidity and better radiographic
evaluation of spinal fusion procedures. The pace of new development in this
field is remarkable. As new products are brought to market, thorough and
rigorous testing in well-designed clinical trials will be required to establish their
ultimate worth.
References
1 Delecrin J, Takahashi S, Gouin F, Passuti N: A synthetic porous ceramic as a bone graft substitute
in the surgical management of scoliosis: A prospective, randomized study. Spine 2000;25:
563569.
2 Khan S, Sandhu H, Parvataneni H, Girardi F, Cammisa F: Bone graft substitutes in spine surgery.
Bull Hosp Jt Dis 2000;59:510.
Resnick/Alexander/Welch 52
dramroo
28 Gogolewski S: Bioresorbable polymers in trauma and bone surgery. Injury 2000;4:2832.
29 An YH, Woolf SK, Friedman RJ: Pre-clinical in vivo evaluation of orthopaedic bioabsorbable
devices. Biomaterials 2000;21:26352652.
30 Viljanen J, Kinnunen J, Bondestam S, Majola A, Rokkanen P, Tormala P: Bone changes after
experimental osteotomies fixed with absorbable self-reinforced poly-L-lactide screws or metallic
screws studied by plain radiographs, quantitative computed tomography, and magnetic resonance
imaging. Biomaterials 1995;16:13531358.
31 Cutright D, Hunsuck E: The repair of fractures of the orbital floor using biodegradable polylactic
acid. Oral Surg 1972;33:28.
32 Getter L, Cutright D, Bhaskar S, Augsburg J: A biodegradable intraosseus appliance in the treat
ment of mandibular fractures. J Oral Surg 1972;30:344.
33 Montag ME, Morales L Jr, Daane S: Bioabsorbables: Their use in pediatric craniofacial surgery.
J Craniofac Surg 1997;8:100102.
34 Bergsma E, Rozema F, Bos R, de Bruijn W: Foreign body reactions to resorbable poly(L-lactide)
bone plates and screws used for the fixation of unstable zygomatic fractures. J Oral Maxillofac
Surg 1993;51:666670.
35 Bergsma J, de Bruijn W, Rozema F, Bos R, Boering G: Late degradation tissue response to
poly(L-lactide) bone plates and screws. Biomaterials 1995;16:2531.
36 Barrows T: Degradable implant materials: A review of synthetic absorbable polymers and their
applications. Clin Mater 1986;1:233.
37 Pietrzak W, Sarver D, Verstynen M: Bioabsorbable polymer science for the practicing surgeon.
J Craniofac Surg 1997;8:8791.
38 Rokkanen PU, Bostman O, Hirvensalo E, et al: Bioabsorbable fixation in orthopaedic surgery and
traumatology. Biomaterials 2000;21:26072613.
39 Vainionpaa S: Surgical applications of biodegradable polymers in human tissue. Prog Polym Sci
1989;14:679716.
40 Bostman O, Hirvensalo E, Makinen J, Rokkanen P: Foreign body reactions to fracture fixation
implants of biodegradable synthetic polymers. J Bone Joint Surg Br 1990;72:592596.
41 Bostman O: Osteolytic changes accompanying degradation of absorbable fracture implants.
J Bone Joint Surg Br 1991;73:679682.
42 Bostman O, Parito E, Hirvensalo E, Rokkanen P: Foreign body reactions to polyglycolide screws:
Observations in 24/26 malleolar fracture cases. Acta Orthop Scand 1992;63:173176.
43 Svensson P, Janarv P, Hirsch G: Internal fixation with biodegradable rods in pediatric fractures:
One year follow-up of fifty patients. J Pediatr Orthop 1994;14:220224.
44 Van der Elst M, Klein C, Bliek-Hogervorst J, Patka P: Bone tissue response to biodegradable poly
mers used for intramedullary fracture fixation: A long-term in vivo study in sheep. Biomaterials
1999;20:121128.
45 Gautier S, Oudega M, Fraguso M, et al: Poly(alpha-hydroxyacids) for application in the spinal
cord: Resorbability and biocompatibility with adult rat Schwann cells and spinal cord. J Biomed
Mater Res 1998;42:642654.
46 Levy F, Hollinger J, Szachowicz E: Effect of a bioresorbable film on regeneration of cranial bone.
Plast Reconstr Surg 1994;93:307311.
47 Lundgren D, Nyman S, Mathisen T, Isaksson S, Klinge B: Guided bone regeneration of cranial
defects using biodegradable barriers: An experimental pilot study in the rabbit. J Craniomaxillofac
Surg 1992;20:257260.
48 Medinaceli L, Khoury R, Merle M: Large amounts of polylactic acid in contact with divided nerve
sheaths have no adverse effects on regeneration. J Reconstr Microsurg 1995;11:4349.
49 Eppley B, Sadove A: Surgical correction of metopic suture synostosis; in Kolk C (ed): Clinics in
Plastic Surgery. Philadelphia, Saunders, 1994, pp 555562.
50 Eppley B, Sadove A: Resorbable coupling fixation in craniosynostosis surgery: Experimental and
clinical applications. J Craniofac Surg 1995;6:477482.
51 Pensler J: Role of resorbable plates and screws in craniofacial surgery. J Craniofac Surg 1997;8:
129134.
52 Kumar A, Staffenberg D, Petronio J, Wood R: Bioabsorbable plates and screws in pediatric cranio
facial surgery: A review of 22 cases. J Craniofac Surg 1997;8:9799.
Daniel K. Resnick, MD MS
Tel. 1 608 263 9651, Fax 1 608 263 1728, E-Mail [email protected]
Resnick/Alexander/Welch 54
dramroo
Haid RW Jr, Subach BR, Rodts GE Jr (eds): Advances in Spinal Stabilization.
No uniform criteria for determining fusion have been used in the reports
of radiographic outcomes of anterior lumbar interbody fusion (ALIF) surgery
[1, 2]. The most commonly reported standard for establishing the presence of a
successful lumbar interbody fusion is evidence of trabecular bone formation
linking the adjacent vertebral bodies. A wide range of fusion rates for the ALIF
procedure has been reported [37]. The variability in fusion rates is, in part,
determined by the surgical technique, the type and quantity of bone graft used,
and the presence of an interbody fusion device. With these variables, the deter
mination of a successful arthrodesis is largely determined by the investigators
definition of fusion.
The use of metallic interbody fusion devices creates new challenges in
establishing fusion criteria. These devices obscure vertebral landmarks used in
the assessment of fusion and create artifacts that degrade some imaging tech
niques [810]. The intradiscal radiographic patterns of fusion after surgery with
interbody fusion cages are determined by the extent of the discectomy, the end
plate preparation, the reaming techniques, the interface between the cage and
the host bone, and the characteristics of the bone graft materials used. Direct
surgical exploration is not a viable option for determining the status of an inter-
body fusion [1113]. Indirect assessment at surgery of an anterior fusion through
the manipulation of the posterior spinous processes is subjective and can iden
tify only gross patterns of instability and cannot reliably identify micromotion
across an interspace.
Other than by histologic biopsy, interbody fusion can only be assessed
objectively by various radiographic imaging techniques. Although the presence
dramroo
of a pseudarthrosis can be determined by a single finding on an isolated radi
ographic study, the presence of a solid fusion cannot be determined by a single
radiographic finding. Failure of fusion is established by the absence of bridging
trabecular bone and the presence of a radiolucent area that extends through the
entire fusion mass. Pseudarthrosis can also be identified by marginal radiolucency
around the implant, progressive subsidence of implants, and angular changes in
the spinal motion segment.
At present, no single study or technique is definitive for establishing the
presence of a fusion after anterior interbody surgery [14]. A successful arthrodesis
within a spinal motion segment can be determined by using radiographic eval
uation to assess a stable spinal alignment on sequential examinations, a reduc
tion in angular and translational changes on dynamic motion studies, an
absence of fibrous tissue reaction at the device-host interface, and the presence
of new bone formation and bone remodeling [15].
The most comprehensive and accurate means of radiographically assessing
fusion of the lumbar spine after ALIF with intradiscal implants are plain radi
ographs, dynamic motion radiographs, and thin-cut computerized tomography
(CT) scans. Technetium bone scans and MR imaging are not effective in assess
ing interbody fusion [9, 16]. Plain radiographs are effective for determining
changes in spinal alignment over time. Dynamic plain radiographs can accu
rately assess changes in implant-host bone interface and instability patterns
within the spinal motion segment. CT imaging can identify new bone formation
and bone remodeling within and around the spinal implants [8, 17]. By using
all three imaging technologies, the physician can accurately determine a suc
cessful and clinically relevant interbody fusion [15].
Plain Radiographs
The plain radiographic studies that are used most often to assess fusion
include the following: (1) standing or weight-bearing radiographs, (2) supine
radiographs, (3) dynamic flexion-extension radiographs, and (4) dynamic side-
bending radiographs. Standing or weight-bearing films are more valuable than
supine films in assessing sagittal plane balance and alignment; a weight-bearing
radiographic technique stresses the interbody fusion can help identify instabil
ity patterns. Supine anteroposterior radiographs show lucencies around metal
lic implants (fig. 1).
Metallic implants create artifacts that make interpretation of plain radi
ographs alone inaccurate in the assessment of fusion [8, 10]. Bone growth within
the implants cannot be assessed on plain radiographs. The thread patterns of
Burkus/Foley/Haid 56
dramroo
a b
interbody fusion cages create varying amounts of artifact at the implant-host bone
interface. Radiographic lucencies in this area can be misinterpreted. The following
findings on plain radiographs help to identify a fusion: (1) incorporation of grafts
to vertebral end plates, (2) bridging trabecular bone across the interspace,
(3) absence of lucencies at the graft-host interface, (4) absence of subsidence, and
(5) absence of graft or implant migration. The absence of subsidence and implant
migration can only be established by a review of serial radiographs.
Burkus/Foley/Haid 58
dramroo
A single CT scan may not be able to distinguish between unincorporated
or necrotic bone grafts from bridging trabecular bone within a metallic fusion
cage. Cunningham et al. [28] analyzed fusion through a histomorphometric
assessment. They could not differentiate between residual autograft and new
bone formation. However, serial CT scans can be used to identify maturation of
corticocancellous grafts within fusion cages and can demonstrate incorporation
of these grafts through the openings in the second-generation fusion cages [26].
CT scans can be used to accurately identify new bone formation within the disc
space but outside of the interbody fusion devices [17, 26, 27].
Spinal Alignment
ALIF using stand-alone implants often improve the frontal and sagittal
plain contours of the lumbar spine. Immediate postoperative improvements in
frontal and sagittal plane contours are not maintained over time in all patients
[3234]. Stand-alone implants are susceptible to subsidence into the vertebral
end plates. Subsidence of the implants, which occurs over the course of several
years after surgery, often leads to segmental spinal instability, loss of lordosis,
angular frontal plain deformities, and sagittal plain translation. It is evidence of
a delayed fusion or frank pseudarthrosis (fig. 2). The ability of an implant to
resist subsidence is, in part, related to its design [35]. Subsidence, loss of disc
space height, and angular deformity are also related to the position of the
implants within the disc space [17, 31].
Interbody fusion can only be determined to be complete if there is no change
in the alignment of the spine at the instrumented fusion site for a minimum of
a b
Burkus/Foley/Haid 60
dramroo
Segmental Spinal Stabilization
Subtle changes in the lumbar contours can be identified on dynamic
lateral radiographs; changes in segmental lordosis and sagittal plane translation
can be identified on these studies. Incorporating known measurement error,
criteria for fusion on dynamic radiographic studies include angular motion
of 3 or less and reduction in sagittal plane or frontal plane translation of
5 mm or less. The documentation of persistent motion across a fused motion
segment has led some clinicians and researchers to conclude that the error in
measuring dynamic plane radiographs often precludes an accurate determi
nation of fusion.
Device-Bone Interface
The host bone reaction to an interbody fusion device helps to ascertain
fusion. Although the composition and shape of the implant influence the
region around the device, the host bone reaction to the implant remains an
important aspect of determining fusion. The presence of sclerosis or cystic
radiolucencies on the margins of the implant within the subchondral bone can
result from bony reabsorption and fibrosis tissue reaction secondary micro
motion in the presence of a pseudarthrosis. Radiolucency surrounding the
implants represents the interposition of fibrous tissue at the host bone-implant
interface. It is commonly agreed that this is also a sign of micromotion and
instability. End plate sclerosis that extends through the subchondral bone and
alters the trabecular pattern of the vertebral body is also consistent with micro
motion and pseudarthrosis. Plain radiographs, dynamic extension radiographs,
and thin-cut CT scans are helpful in assessing the device-bone interface. These
changes can be seen on plain radiographs but are best detailed on thin-cut
CT scans.
Progressive collapse of the interspace and migration of implants are gross
radiographic signs of instability, delayed union, and pseudarthrosis. Plain
radiographs can also identify migration and subsidence of the implants within
the disc space. Dynamic lateral extension radiographs help to identify subtle
patterns of motion at the disc space and can help to identify interface lucen
cies. If a fusion is not present, hyperextension lateral radiographs can increase
the gap between the implant and host bone. This gap appears as increased
radiolucency surrounding the implant or may appear as a gap in the anterior
fusion mass.
Thin-cut CT scans are best at detailing cystic changes within the vertebral
end plates, sclerosis, and interface lucency. Heithoff et al. [10] found CT scans
of little value in assessing fusion for the first-generation BAK cages. It is diffi
cult to assess for fusion in patients with the thick-walled and square-threaded
BAK cage because of the radiographic scatter inherently associated with its
design. However, end plate sclerosis and the presence of cyst formation within
the end plate adjacent to the implants can be readily determined even on these
first-generation implants (fig. 4). The interface between the host bone and tita
nium implants can be more easily assessed with second-generation cages such
as the INTER FIX (Medtronic Sofamor Danek, Memphis, Tenn., USA) and
LT-Cage (Medtronic Sofamor Danek). The thread patterns on these cages are
self-tapping and thinner than on earlier devices. The radiographic scatter and
artifact are reduced. With the second-generation cages, it is possible to assess
the interface between the implant and the host bone for the development of
fibrous lucency.
The assessment of interbody fusion with cortical allografts must include
incorporation of the graft materials in addition to the morcellized autogenous
grafts. Complete fusion of an allograft-autograft montage must include incor
poration of the allograft into both vertebral end plates and trabecular bone for
mation across the interspace [22, 36]. With threaded cylindrical bone dowels
and femoral rings, it is possible to determine incorporation of the allograft to
end plates of the host vertebra. On plain radiographs and CT scans, it is common
to find early trabecular bone formation crossing the interspace. In the presence
of spanning trabecular bone formation around the implant, there is often incor
poration of the allograft to only one vertebral end plate. The lucencies surround
ing the contact points of the allograft to one end plate often resolve over time
[34, 37, 38]. They are commonly present at 1 year after surgery and do not
Burkus/Foley/Haid 62
dramroo
a b
Fig. 6. a Coronal CT scan reconstruction shows two LT-Cage devices centrally placed
in the L5S1 disc space 48 h after surgery. The cages were filled with InFUSE bone graft
substitute (rhBMP-2 and an absorbable collagen sponge). No autogenous grafts were placed
within the disc space or cage. b At 1 year after surgery, there is new formation within both
cages. There is also new bone formation outside the cages in the lateral fusion zones. All new
bone formation remains confined to the disc space.
the cages in an area where no bone graft was placed is the most important
radiographic sign indicating fusion. Similarly, identification of annular ossifi
cation and bridging osteophytes crossing a disc space are secondary signs of
new bone formation after a successful interbody fusion.
Burkus/Foley/Haid 64
dramroo
Posterior
zone
Anterior
zone
bone formation had occurred outside of the cages in the rhBMP-2 group by 6
months after surgery, and it occurred in all patients by 24 months [26, 27].
New bone formation within the cages occurred most markedly during the first
612 months after surgery; rates of new bone formation exceeded those of the
autograft control group. All new bone formation outside of the cages occurred
within the confines of the disc space. All CT scan slices and all reconstructed
images were studied to evaluate new bone formation. No new bone formation
extended outside of the annulus fibrosus; no bone growth was observed
extending posteriorly into the spinal canal or posterolaterally into the neuro
foramina.
Fusion Zones
New bone formation in a region or zone of the interspace that is free of
autogenous graft or growth factors represents osteoinduction within the soft
tissue elements of the spinal motion segment. Identifying osteoinduction
within the disc space is the most accurate means of determining fusion after
an ALIF procedure. New bone formation only occurs in a spinal motion
segment that is adequately stabilized and, therefore, represents a fused motion
segment. Five fusion zones have been established for interbody fusion
devices. The zones of fusion can be assessed on plain radiographs and CT
scans.
The anterior zone is an area of bone formation in front of the cages along
the anterior margins of the disc space (fig. 7). Bone formation in this zone is
the least reliable indication of interbody fusion. The formation of radial
osteophytes, which is indicative of instability, often masquerades as an early
sentinel sign. On the basis of anterior bone formation alone, it is impossible
to tell if it is a good sign or a bad sign. For a fusion to be present, trabecular bone
formation in the anterior zone must be complete from end plate to end plate.
Bone formation that extends past the confines of the disc space can be an early
indication of a developing pseudarthrosis (fig. 8). Frequently the sentinel sign
represents radial bone spur formation, not interbody fusion. The isolated
sentinel sign may indicate progressive instability instead of progressive
fusion.
The posterior zone is the posterior margin of the interspace (see fig. 7).
Trabecular bone formation in this zone is most likely the best radiographic
indication of interbody fusion. Bone formation in the posterior zone is the most
reliable indication of fusion.
The lateral zone or the lateral margins of the disc space are divided into left
and right regions (fig. 9). Bone formation between the lateral borders of the
implants and the annulus is difficult to visualize on plain radiographs. On
anteroposterior and Ferguson views at the L45 and L5S1 interspace, the
posterior facet joints overlie the lateral fusion zones and early bone formation
in the lateral zone on these plain radiographs. CT scans are essential in visualiz
ing early trabecular bone formation in the lateral zones (fig. 10). Only the final
stages of ossification of the annulus fibrosus are apparent on plain anteropos
terior radiographs. Bone formation in these zones is also a very good predictor
of fusion and typically occurs here before it does in the posterior zone. Bone
formation with the two lateral zones is often asymmetric; this may be related to
asymmetric cage placement.
The between zone is the area of bone formation between the implants
(fig. 9, 11). Bone formation in this zone is best visualized with thin-cut CT
scans and in those patients where the implants have been adequately spaced
away from each other.
Burkus/Foley/Haid 66
dramroo
Bone graft
Bone graft
in lateral
in lateral
zone
zone Posterior
zone
Lateral Lateral
zone zone
Bone graft
between cages Anterior
zone
9 10
Fig. 9. Anteroposterior view of the lateral zones and the between zone. The interbody
fusion cages are placed equidistant from the midline of the disc space. However, there is space
between the cage walls and the annulus fibrosus that compromises new bone formation in the
lateral zone.
Fig. 10. Drawing of an axial CT scan shows the position of the anterior, posterior, and
lateral zones.
The within zone is the area of bone formation within the interbody fusion
device (fig. 9, 11). It is very difficult to differentiate between living and dead
bone within the cages. The size, configuration, and material of the cages also sig
nificantly influence the ability to accurately assess bone formation in this zone.
Assessment of bone formation is not practical with a single CT scan. It is best
assessed over time with serial CT scans.
References
1 Frymoyer JW, Hanley EN Jr, Howe J, Kuhlmann D, Matteri RE: A comparison of radiographic
findings in fusion and nonfusion patients ten or more years following lumbar disc surgery. Spine
1979;4:435440.
2 Weiner BK, Fraser RD: Spine update: Lumbar interbody cages. Spine 1998;23:634640.
3 Crock HV: Anterior lumbar interbody fusion: Indications for its use and notes on surgical tech
nique. Clin Orthop 1982;165:157163.
Burkus/Foley/Haid 68
dramroo
4 Harmon PH: Anterior excision and vertebral body fusion operation for intervertebral disc
syndromes of the lower lumbar spine. Clin Orthop 1963;26:107127.
5 Kuslich SD, Ulstrom CL, Griffith SL, Ahern JW, Dowdle JD: The Bagby and Kuslich method of
lumbar interbody fusion. History, techniques, and 2-year follow-up results of a United States
prospective, multicenter trial. Spine 1998;23:12671278.
6 Lane JD, Moore ES: Transperitoneal approach to the intervertebral disc in the lumbar area. Ann
Surg 1948;127:537551.
7 Ray CD: Threaded titanium cages for lumbar interbody fusions. Spine 1997;22:667679.
8 Cizek GR, Boyd LM: Imaging pitfalls of interbody spinal implants. Spine 2000;25:26332636.
9 Djukic S, Lang P, Hoaglund F, Genant HK: The postoperative spine. Magnetic resonance imaging.
Orthop Clin North Am 1990;21:603624.
10 Heithoff KB, Mullin JW, Holte D, Renfrew DL, Gilbert TJ: Failure of radiographic detection of
pseudarthrosis in patients with titanium lumbar interbody fusion cages. Proceedings of the 14th
Annual Meeting North American Spine Society, Chicago, 1999, pp 1417.
11 Kant AP, Daum WJ, Dean SM, Uchida T: Evaluation of lumbar spine fusion. Plain radiographs
versus direct surgical exploration and observation. Spine 1995;20:23132317.
12 Sandhu HS, Toth JM, Diwan AD, Seim HB 3rd, Kanim LE, Kabo JM, Turner AS: Histologic eval
uation of efficacy of rhBMP-2 compared with autograft bone in sheep spinal anterior interbody
fusion. Spine 2002;27:567575.
13 Steinmann JC, Herkowitz HN: Pseudarthrosis of the spine. Clin Orthop 1992;284:8090.
14 Watkins R: Anterior lumbar interbody fusion surgical complications. Clin Orthop 1992;284:4753.
15 Burkus JK, Foley K, Haid R, LeHuec JC: Radiographic assessment of interbody fusion devices:
Fusion criteria for anterior lumbar interbody surgery. Surgical Interbody Research Group. Neurosurg
Focus 2001;10/4:19.
16 Hannon KM, Wetta WJ: Failure of technetium bone scanning to detect pseudarthroses in spinal
fusion for scoliosis. Clin Orthop 1977;123:4244.
17 Gilbert TJ, Heithoff KB, Mullin WJ: Radiographic assessment of cage-assisted interbody fusions
in the lumbar spine. Semin Spine Surg 2001;13/4:311315.
18 Brantigan JW: Carbon fiber interbody fusion cages: Indications, results and radiographic inter
pretation of fusion. Spine State Art Rev 1997;11:287306.
19 Zdeblick TA: A prospective randomized study of lumbar fusion. Preliminary results. Spine 1993;
18:983991.
20 Pearcy M, Burrough S: Assessment of bony union after interbody fusion of the lumbar spine using
a biplanar radiographic technique. J Bone Joint Surg Br 1982;64:228232.
21 Heggeness MH, Esses SI: Classification of pseudarthroses of the lumbar spine. Spine 1991;
16(suppl):S449S454.
22 Rothman SL, Glenn WV Jr: CT evaluation of interbody fusion. Clin Orthop 1985;193:4756.
23 Siambanes D, Mather S: Comparison of plain radiographs and CT scans in instrumented posterior
lumbar interbody fusion. Orthopedics 1998;21:165167.
24 Boden SD, Martin GJ Jr, Horton WC, Truss TL, Sandhu HS: Laproscopic anterior spinal arthrode
sis with rhBMP-2 in titanium interbody threaded cage. J Spinal Disord 1998;11:95101.
25 Boden SD, Zdeblick TA, Sandhu HS, Heim SE: The use of rhBMP-2 in interbody fusion cages.
Definitive evidence of osteoinduction in humans: A preliminary report. Spine 2000;25:376381.
26 Burkus JK, Dorchak JD, Sanders DL: Prospective randomized study of radiographic assessment
of interbody fusion using rhBMP-2. Proceedings of the 16th Annual Meeting North American
Spine Society, Seattle, 2001, p 98.
27 Gornet M, Burkus JK, Dickman C, Zdeblick TA: RhBMP-2 with tapered cages: A prospective,
randomized lumbar fusion study. Proceedings of the 16th Annual Meeting North American Spine
Society, Seattle, 2001, pp 2122.
28 Cunningham BW, Kanayama M, Parker LM, Weis JC, Sefter JC, Fedder IL, McAfee PC: Osteogenic
protein versus autologous interbody arthrodesis in the sheep thoracic spine: A comparative endo
scopic study using the Bagby and Kuslich interbody fusion device. Spine 1999;24:509518.
29 McAfee PC: Interbody fusion cages in reconstructive operations on the spine. J Bone Joint Surg
Am 1999;81:859880.
J. K. Burkus, MD
Tel. 1 706 576 3239, Fax 1 706 571 2502, E-Mail [email protected]
Burkus/Foley/Haid 70
dramroo
Neuronavigational Advances
Image-Guided Technology
Spinal Stereotaxis
McLaughlin/Bartolomei 72
dramroo
Fig. 1. The Stealthstation (Medtronic Sofamor Danek) includes a high-powered
computer and high-resolution monitor. The display generates triplanar images and a 3-D
model of the patients spine. After registration, the digitized instruments are passed through
the operative field and are displayed on the monitor.
process (fig. 2). It has been our experience that the spinous process is the most
secure and reliable landmark for anchoring the reference arch. The arc should
be placed at each vertebral level being registered and instrumented. At L5, S1
it is useful to place the reference arc on the sacral spinous process with the
angled arch toward the feet. This allows for free movement of the surgeons
hands and instruments without interference of the arc. For upper lumbar and
thoracic instrumentation, the arc should be placed pointing cephalad.
Once the reference arc has been secured, it must be visible to the optical
camera (fig. 3). The surgeon can then register analogous anatomical points on
the computer and on the patients spine. For registration in the lumbar and tho
racic regions specific landmarks include the middle posterior lateral aspect of
the transverse process tips bilaterally, the inferior and superior aspect of the
spinous process tips, the mamillary tubercles as the base of the transverse
processes (when present) (fig. 4).
These points are easily identifiable both on the computer model as well as
the patients spine. Once the reference arc is placed and registration is complete
the computer will then verify the location of the patients spinal anatomy in
relation to the operating room with submillimetric precision. Accuracy is con
firmed by correlating the patients anatomy with the computer model. Digitized
instruments then can be moved within the operative field and using both
passive and active light-admitting diodes (LED). Frameless navigation can be
performed. Standard lumbar instrumentation equipment is available and digitized
McLaughlin/Bartolomei 74
dramroo
Fig. 3. The optical camera must be positioned approximately 6 ft away from the refer
ence arc. It must have unobstructed views of the LEDs on the reference arc and the digitized
instruments.
including a probe-all drill guide and tap that can contact the spine. With each
movement, the surgeon can look on the computer screen and visualize the
instruments in relation to the patients spine. Images are available in the axial,
sagittal and coronal planes as well as a 3-D image. This allows the surgeon to
see the anatomy in any of the three necessary planes. As an instrument is passed
Virtual Fluoroscopy
McLaughlin/Bartolomei 76
dramroo
5 6
Fig. 5. The Fluoronav system (Medtronic Sofamor Danek) includes a workstation with
a high-powered computer and a high-resolution monitor, an optical camera, and an attach
ment with LEDs and fiducial display for the C-arm.
Fig. 6. The C-arm is modified slightly in that a fiducial display is attached to the
receiver. This metallic attachment contains LEDs that the optical camera sees to begin the
registration process.
The surgeon can choose any instrument needed for pedicle screw place
ment and a single universal instrument handle is attached. The software system
projects to the computer screen a virtual instrument in relation to fluoroscopic
image of the spine.
Various instruments can be projected onto the screen. As the instruments
move in real time with surgeon manipulation, the changes are replicated instan
taneously on the computer screen. The surgeon is thus aware of the depth and
specific location of the instrument at all times. Distances such as pedicle length
can be calculated and screw angulation for optimal screw trajectory can be
determined with simple movements of the hand.
Because virtual fluoroscopy relies on fluoroscopic images, it is most useful
in navigating bony anatomy. Tumor resections and soft tissue abnormalities are
not suited to virtual fluoroscopy but are best suited for standard frameless
stereotaxis. Patients with 3-D or coronal deformities are also unsuitable candi
dates for virtual fluoroscopy and would be better suited for frameless stereo
tactic techniques as well.
Another spinal navigational system has recently gained popularity with the
advancement in fluoro to CT registration technology in which the two fluoro
scopic images are used to noninvasively merge into the preoperative CT image
data set (Vector Vision, Brainlab, Germany) (fig. 7). A preoperative CT scan
with the standard image-guided protocol is necessary prior to using the fluoro
to CT registration technology. This protocol consists of 1-mm axial cuts incor
porating one or two levels above and below the area of interest or the surgical
field where instrumentation is going to be placed. The images are then trans
ported via ether net or zip drive into the working station where a 3-D image is
created. With the 3-D image operative planning can be performed such as iden
tification of entry and target points for pedicle, transarticular, and lateral mass
screw insertion or biopsies.
McLaughlin/Bartolomei 78
dramroo
Fig. 8. Computer screen displaying (clockwise) 3-D image, lateral fluoro image, axial
CT, and Auto Pilot view while inserting a pedicle screw.
Once the images are transformed into a 3-D rendition, surgical exposure
is obtained in a standard fashion and the reference array is clamped to the spin
ous process. A new device is also available that allows the reference array to be
placed anteriorly into the vertebral body if an anterior surgical approach is
desired. This has been described previously with other systems [32]. By adjust
ing the flexible joints, the reference clamp can be positioned without obstruct
ing the surgical field. Once the array is secured AP and lateral fluoroscopic
images over the area to be instrumented are obtained. There are three methods
for registration. Like other systems there is the paired point registration in
which anatomical landmarks are identified and registered on both the spine and
on the CT images, and there is the surface matching algorithm in which ten or
more points are rapidly collected on the surface of the spine and registered
to the CT images. As mentioned above, unique to the Brain Lab system is the
fluoro to CT registration.
Fluoro to CT registration is performed by matching on the computer
screen the vertebral body of interest in a spine model to the AP and lateral films
obtained. Once the vertebral bodies are identified and matched, it takes approx
imately 5 min for the software to register and have a navigational 3-D image.
Once registered, the software allows the surgeon to navigate in 3-D, CT, and
fluoro images or a combination of all by adjusting the computer screen (fig. 8).
When targeting a specific end point such as a lesion biopsy or placement of
a pedicle screw, the Brain Lab provides a software called Auto Pilot view that
enables safe navigation and instant feedback. The tool consists of a series of
aligned concentric circles forming a tunnel on a direct path to the target. The first
concentric circle is the entry point and the target point is the smallest black circle
at the end of the tunnel. If during navigation there are any deviations from the
trajectory, the tunnel will curve as the last and first circle become noncongruent.
The software provides immediate feedback providing distance to end point or
any compensatory changes in direction (i.e. angle) necessary to safely reach the
desired target. This tool can be used on difficult cases were the anatomy might
be distorted such as in scoliotic patients or when performing percutaneous
pedicle screw insertion where visible landmarks are not available (fig. 9).
McLaughlin/Bartolomei 80
dramroo
The Brain Lab system allows the surgeon to adapt any desired instrument
into the image-guided field. This is performed by clamping a passive marker
array to any instrument (i.e. penfield, pedicle finder, tap, or awl) and inserting
the tip of the instrument into the calibration matrix box. This allows any
instrument to be utilized during the surgery.
Conclusions
References
1 Abdel-Malek K, et al: Bone registration method for robot assisted surgery: Pedicle screw inser
tion. Proc Inst Mech Eng 1997;211/3:221233.
2 Berlemann U, et al: Reliability of pedicle screw assessment utilizing plain radiographs versus CT
reconstruction. Eur Spine J 1997;6:406410.
3 Bolger C, Wigfield C: Image-guided surgery: Applications to the cervical and thoracic spine and
a review of the first 120 procedures. J Neurosurg 2000;92:175180.
4 Brodwater BK, Roberts DW, Nakajima T, Friets EM, Strohbehn JW: Extracranial application of
the frameless stereotactic operating microscope: Experience with lumbar spine. Neurosurgery
1993;32/2:209213.
5 Carl AL, et al: In vitro simulation. Early results of stereotaxy for pedicle screw placement. Spine
1997;22:11601164.
McLaughlin/Bartolomei 82
dramroo
33 Weinstein JN, Spratt KF, Spengler D, et al: Spinal pedicle fixation: reliability and validity of
roentgenogram-based assessment and surgical factors on successful screw placement. Spine
1988;13:10121018.
34 Welch WC, Subach BR, Pollack IF, Jacobs GB: Frameless stereotactic guidance for surgery of
the upper cervical spine. Neurosurgery 1997;40:958963.
35 Xu R, et al: Anatomic considerations of pedicle screw placement in the thoracic spine. Roy-Camille
technique versus open-lamina technique. Spine 1998;23:10651068.
Mark R. McLaughlin, MD
Neuro-Group, PA, 123 Franklin Corner Road
Lawrenceville, NJ 08648 (USA)
Tel. 1 609 895 8898, Fax 1 609 895 8330, E-Mail [email protected]
dramroo
to a change in the patients overall position compared to their preoperative position
or following a reduction maneuver cannot be updated without the presence of an
intraoperative CT or MRI. This limitation mandates that each segment be individ
ually registered to provide maximal navigational accuracy at that respective
segment. As previously stated, this can often be a rate-limiting step to the novice
user of a conventional 3D image guidance system. Furthermore, the accuracy pro
vided by these systems is often felt to be unnecessary for the majority of spinal
procedures. These limitations continue to drive the need to develop more user-
friendly and practical computer-assisted techniques, such as virtual fluoroscopy.
C-arm fluoroscopy is an intraoperative imaging technique that is familiar
to all spine surgeons. It is routinely employed for real-time intraoperative local
ization of patient anatomy and surgical instruments in a variety of spinal
procedures. Fluoroscopic localization facilitates improved accuracy and in
many instances reduces surgical exposure in a variety of spinal procedures such
as pedicle screw insertion, interbody cage placement, odontoid screw insertion,
and atlantoaxial transarticular screw fixation. This imaging technology has also
enabled the development of percutaneous spinal procedures, such as vertebro
plasty. Despite the advantages of intraoperative fluoroscopy, there are several
limitations. Without a second fluoroscope, only a single projection can be visu
alized at one time. This limitation makes it necessary to reposition the C-arm
during procedures that require multiple planes of visualization. Frequent
repositioning of the C-arm is tedious, time-consuming, and frustrating. In addi
tion, maintaining ideal sterility is a challenge. Furthermore, the position(s) of
the C-arm is often ergonomically challenging to the surgeon. Finally, the
potential deleterious effect of repeated radiation exposure to the surgeons
hands is always an important consideration [3].
Combining neuronavigational technology with a standard C-arm fluoroscope
has enabled the optimization of this versatile intraoperative imaging modality.
A computer-assisted image-guided fluoroscopy (virtual fluoroscopy) system
provides the user with real-time multiplanar anatomical localization of a tracked
surgical instrument in relation to patient-specific fluoroscopic-based images
[48]. These systems eliminate the need for special preoperative imaging stud
ies, manual image to patient registration (see above), C-arm repositioning, or the
associated ergonomic challenges of using a C-arm fluoroscope. Furthermore,
patient and occupational radiation exposure is significantly reduced, as is the need
for wearing lead protection. Virtual fluoroscopy is currently being used for a wide
variety of spinal applications. It is also being used for assistance in osseous cranial
navigation (e.g. transsphenoidal access to the parasellar region) [9]. In addition,
these systems are being extensively used for a variety of orthopedic trauma proce
dures and more recently total joint replacement. A novel variant of this technology
is also being utilized in interventional radiology.
Virtual Fluoroscopy 85
dramroo
System Overview
Rampersaud/Foley 86
dramroo
a b
Fig. 1. AP and lateral virtual fluoroscopic views of the lumbar spine. Note the high-
grade spondylolisthesis. a The pedicle probe (dark line) has been positioned at the pedicle
entry point (white arrowhead). Its trajectory (light line) has been virtually extended 15 mm
to the base of the pedicle (black arrow). b Pedicle probe advancement is displayed in both
the AP and lateral images simultaneously.
Accuracy Validation
Bench top testing of these systems has shown excellent (submillimetric)
correlation of the live fluoroscopic position of a probe and its virtual fluoro
scopic projection. In a simulated operating room setting, Foley et al. [4] inves
tigated the in vitro accuracy of the FluoroNav (Medtronic Surgical Navigation
Systems, Louisville, Colo., USA) system. In this study, the difference in posi
tioning of an implanted pedicle probe (tip and trajectory angle) was measured
comparing live and virtual fluoroscopic images. The mean error in probe tip
localization was 0.97 0.40 mm (99% confidence interval 2.2 mm, maximum
probe tip error 3 mm). The mean trajectory angle difference between the vir
tual and actual probe images was 2.7 0.6 (99% confidence interval 4.6,
maximum trajectory angle difference 5).
Virtual Fluoroscopy 87
dramroo
parallax. Furthermore, a true image should always be obtained if possible (e.g.
in a true anterior-posterior (AP) view, the spinous process should bisect the
pedicle). Prior to clinical use, it must be clearly understood that virtual fluo
roscopy systems typically cannot improve the image quality generated by a
given C-arm and it cannot compensate for a surgeons misinterpretation of
fluoroscopic (2D) osseous anatomic data. Therefore, a sound knowledge of
fluoroscopic spinal anatomy is essential for the successful use of a virtual
fluoroscopy system.
Virtual fluoroscopy is presently being used for the following spinal proce
dures: open pedicle screw placement (C7S1), percutaneous pedicle screw
placement (T10S1), lumbar interbody cage insertion, C1C2 transarticular
screw placement, lateral mass screw placement, odontoid screw fixation and
transoral decompression.
Rampersaud/Foley 88
dramroo
Fig. 2. AP and lateral virtual fluoroscopic views of the lumbar spine (same patient as
in fig. 1). The ability to follow the course of the pedicle probe simultaneously in the AP and
lateral planes enables reliable placement of the probe along an intended trajectory.
Advancement of image-guided pedicle probe trough the S1 pedicle to the sacral promontory
(white arrow) is demonstrated.
screw system the pedicle is probed and tapped under virtual fluoroscopic assis
tance (fig. 3) [10].
Anterior-Cervical Spine
The surface anatomy of the anterior cervical spine is typically prohibitive
to anatomical registration using conventional 3D neuronavigation. Furthermore,
the anatomy of the anterior cervical spine and the nature of anterior cervical
spinal procedures typically do not allow the practical or safe attachment of a
DRA directly to the spine. At the craniocervical junction, the anatomical rela
tionship of the occiput-C1-C2 can often be maintained by the use of a Mayfield
apparatus. As a result of the rigid relationship between the Mayfield apparatus
and the occiput, a DRA directly attached to the Mayfield combined with auto
matic registration enables virtual fluoroscopic navigation during procedures at
the craniocervical junction (e.g. odontoid screw insertion or transoral decom
pression). For anterior procedures of the subaxial cervical spine, the DRA can
be directly attached to one or more vertebral bodies using threaded distraction
pins. As noted for posterior procedures, the multiplanar position and trajectory
of tracked surgical tools are provided in real time. Specific to anterior cervical
procedures, information with respect to the anatomical midline and depth is
also utilized.
Virtual Fluoroscopy 89
dramroo
3a
Pedicle probe
Projected trajectory
of pedicle probe Dorsal
Dorsal
Medial Medial
Lateral
Spinal cord
Ventral Ventral
3D AP Lateral
3b
3e
3c
3f
3d 3g
Rampersaud/Foley 90
dramroo
Clinical Outcomes
Virtual Fluoroscopy 91
dramroo
a b
Disadvantages
Rampersaud/Foley 92
dramroo
the fluoroscopically generated images and the surgeons ability to meaningfully
interpret these views are unchanged compared to conventional fluoroscopy.
For all current image guidance systems, the navigational accuracy is greatest
at the spinal segment to which the DRA is attached. The rigid relationship between
the DRA and the spinal segment to which it is attached allows for accurate track
ing and compensation for any motion occurring at that specific spinal segment. As
a result of intersegmental motion and other technical reasons, overall navigational
accuracy decreases as one moves further away from the DRA. Consequently, to
maintain maximal navigational accuracy, the DRA should be moved to each spinal
segment of interest with new fluoroscopic images acquired at each segment. This,
however, is clinically impractical for multilevel cases. Unless gross segmental
spinal instability is present, acceptable clinical accuracy is typically maintained
for 25 spinal segments for one DRA position (1 segment: above, 1: at and 13:
below). However, clinical judgment must be used to determine whether the system
is adequately correlating to the segment of interest before navigation is carried out.
For spinal procedures such as C12 transarticular screws where a low margin of
error exists the DRA must be attached to the vertebrae of interest. Furthermore, by
obtaining a live image to confirm the position of a tracked instrument the fluoro
scope can serve as its own internal validation system.
Although virtual fluoroscopy provides the advantages of intraoperative imag
ing, it is still limited by the inability to easily track multiple spinal segments.
Therefore, it is still necessary (for the reasons mentioned above) to move the DRA
and acquire new fluoroscopic images several times during long segment proce
dures. The overall number of C-arm positional changes and images required,
however, is still much less when compared to conventional C-arm fluoroscopy.
Under ideal circumstances surgical navigational systems can be very accu
rate. However, there are numerous potential sources of error that can significantly
affect the clinical accuracy of any image guidance system. These include errors
related to imaging, tracking, registration algorithm(s), and the tracked surgical
tools. These errors, although typically submillimetric, are cumulative and can
result in a clinically significant overall navigational error. One of the potentially
largest, but often understated sources of errors is the surgeon. Like any other
tool, a virtual fluoroscopic navigational system is only as good as its user.
Sound knowledge of the limitations associated with these systems is paramount
for their optimal use.
Future Implications
Virtual Fluoroscopy 93
dramroo
surgical navigational technology has enabled a robust platform from which only
improvement is possible. Virtual fluoroscopy has the potential to bring practi
cal 3D intraoperative image guidance to the operating room. This is currently
evolving in two pathways. The first is a direct method utilizing a novel isocen
tric C-arm (Siemens). This C-arm is capable of generating a 3D image data set,
therefore allowing 3D neuronavigation without the hassles of 3D registration.
Furthermore, because it is an intraoperative imaging device certain limitations
such as positional (patient) intersegmental motion and intraoperative image
update of conventional 3D neuronavigation are eliminated. The second pathway
involves technology that allows automated registration of intraoperative 2D
fluoroscopic images to a preacquired 3D image data set [14]. The goal of both
techniques is to eliminate the time-consuming step of tactile anatomic registra
tion, while providing unparalleled 3D anatomic information and practical
intraoperative imaging capabilities. 2D to 3D image fusion also allows incor
poration of multiple imaging modalities (e.g. CT, MRI, ultrasound or angio
graphic). The added anatomical detail of a 3D image data set without the need
for tactile registration is ideally suited for the refinement and development of
percutaneous or minimal access spinal surgery.
Virtual fluoroscopy is also facilitating another exciting area of research
that involves practical solutions for tracking multiple segments of the spine.
Combined with segmentation of an image data set this will allow the user to
maintain optimal navigational accuracy over numerous segments and update
the relative position of individual segments in real time. Finally, it is only
logical that this technology will likely be integrated directly into the C-arm
fluoroscope, thus providing a versatile intraoperative imaging-navigational
system.
Conclusion
Rampersaud/Foley 94
dramroo
References
1 Foley KT, Smith MM: Image-guided spine surgery. Neurosurg Clin N Am 1996;7/2:171186.
2 Rampersaud YR, Foley KF: Image-guided spinal surgery. Operative Tech Orthopaed 2000;10/1:
6468.
3 Rampersaud YR, Foley KT, Shen AC, Williams S, Solomito M: Radiation exposure to the spine
4 Foley KT, Rampersaud YR, Simon DA: Virtual fluoroscopy: Multi-planar x-ray guidance with
Edith Cavell Wing, 1-039, 399 Bathurst St., Toronto, ON M5T 2S8 (Canada)
Tel. 1 416 603 5399, Fax 1 416 603 3437, E-Mail [email protected]
Virtual Fluoroscopy 95
dramroo
Haid RW Jr, Subach BR, Rodts GE Jr (eds): Advances in Spinal Stabilization.
Screws
The opinions or assertions contained herein are the private views of the authors and are
not to be construed as official or as reflecting the views of the United States Army or the
Department of Defense. The authors are employees of the United States government. This
work was prepared as part of their official duties and as such, there is no copyright to be
transferred.
dramroo
Fluoro guidance
2-D guidance
Fig. 2. This example of 2-D image guidance demonstrates two planar images allowing
the surgeon to navigate simultaneously in these planes. Advantages of this include familiar
ity of the display (fluoroscopy) and the ability to update the images intraoperatively as
needed.
Fig. 3. This example of 3-D image guidance demonstrates the utility of multiplanar
navigation. It allows for simultaneous sagittal, coronal and axial planar navigation. This
allows for true optimization of pedicle screw fit, fill and trajectory.
Pedicle Anatomy
Applied thoracic pedicle anatomy has been well studied, and normative
tables and graphs have been developed [7, 8, 14, 16, 22, 24, 3538, 40, 41].
Currently, there are primarily two accepted screw trajectories the straight-
ahead trajectory (initially popularized by Roy-Camille, then Suk and Lenke),
and the anatomic trajectory (utilized by Harms and others, the term initially
suggested by Polly) [31].
Advantages of the straight-ahead trajectory include permitting the use of a
fixed head (monoaxial) screw, as well as offering increased insertional torque
Polly/Kuklo 98
dramroo
and pull-out strength when compared to the anatomic trajectory [17, 19]. The
major disadvantage is that this trajectory may require the screw to traverse a
narrower portion of the pedicle isthmus to remain fully contained. The
anatomic trajectory (directed along the sagittal pedicle axis a 22 inclination
from dorsal rostral to ventral caudal) permits the surgeon to navigate a larger
portion of the pedicle isthmus and place a longer screw within the bone. It may
also provide a toenail effect, which typically provides the advantage of not
sustaining direct in-line pull-out forces to the screw. Any potential benefit in
construct performance, as opposed to individual screw performance, is
unknown.
Polly/Kuklo 100
dramroo
thus providing an excellent adjunct in pedicle navigation. The merging of
multiple modalities could further enhance the margin of safety provided for
navigating these narrow access corridors.
4a
T5 T6
4b 4c
T7 T8
4d 4e
T9 T10
4f 4g
Polly/Kuklo 102
dramroo
T11 T12
4h 4i
L1 L2
4j 4k
L3
4l
Conclusions
Polly/Kuklo 104
dramroo
References
1 Amiot LP, Labelle H, DeGuise JA, et al: Computer-assisted pedicle screw fixation: A feasibility
study. Spine 1995;20:12081212.
2 Belmont PJ, Klemme WR, Dhawan A, Polly DW: In vivo accuracy of thoracic pedicle screws.
Spine 2001;26:23402346.
3 Berlemann U, Heini P, Mller U, Stoupis C, Schwarzenbach O: Reliability of pedicle screw assess
ment utilizing plain radiographs versus CT reconstruction. Eur Spine J 1997;6:406411.
4 Carl AL, Khanuja HS, Sachs BL, et al: In vitro simulation: Early results of stereotaxy for pedicle
screw placement. Spine 1997;22:11601164.
5 Cinotti G, Gumina S, Ripani M, et al: Pedicle instrumentation in the thoracic spine. Spine
1999;24/21:114119.
6 Dvorak M, MacDonald S, Gurr KR, Bailey SI, Haddad RG: An anatomic, radiographic, and
biomechanical assessment of extrapedicular screw fixation in the thoracic spine. Spine
1993;18:16891694.
7 Ebraheim NA, Jabaly G, Xu R, et al: Anatomic relations of the thoracic pedicle to the adjacent
neural structures. Spine 1997;22:15531557.
8 Ebraheim NA, Xu R, Ahmad M, et al: Projection of the thoracic pedicle and its morphometric
analysis. Spine 1997;22/3:233238.
9 Farber GI, Place HM, Mazur RA, Jones CDE, Damiano TR: Accuracy of pedicle screw placement
in lumbar fusions by plain radiographs and computed tomography. Spine 1995;13:14941499.
10 Gaines RW: The use of pedicle screw internal fixation for the operative treatment of spinal disorders.
J Bone Joint Surg Am 2000;82:14581476.
11 Gertzbein SD, Robbins SE: Accuracy of pedicular screw placement in vivo. Spine 1990;15:1114.
12 Kim KD, Johnson JP, Bloch O, Masciopinto JE: Computer-assisted thoracic pedicle screw place
ment: An in vitro feasibility study. Spine 2001;26:360364.
13 Klemme WR, Belmont PJ, Polly DW: Transpedicular thoracic screws: General concepts and inser
tion technique using fluoroscopic guidance. Semin Spine Surg 2002;14/1:4347.
14 Kothe R, Panjabi MM, Liu W: Multidirectional instability of the thoracic spine due to iatrogenic
pedicle injuries during transpedicular fixation. A biomechanical investigation. Spine
1997;22:18361842.
15 Kuklo TR, Lehman RA, Schroeder T: Perils and pitfalls of thoracic pedicle screw placement.
Semin Spine Surg 2002;14/1:97102.
16 Kuklo TR, Polly DW: Anatomy of the thoracic pedicle. Semin Spine Surg 2002;14/1:37.
17 Lehman RA, Kuklo TR: Pedicle screw salvage using anatomic trajectory. Scoliosis Research
Society Annual Meeting, Seattle, 2002.
18 Lehman RA, Kuklo TR, Orchowski JR, Potter BK, Polly DW: Probing for detection of thoracic
pedicle breach: Is it valid? Scoliosis Research Society Annual Meeting, Seattle, 2002.
19 Lehman RA, Polly DW, Kuklo TR, Belmont PJ, Cunningham B, Kirk KL: Advantage of straight
forward versus anatomic trajectory for placement of thoracic pedicle screws: A biomechanical
study. Scoliosis Research Society Annual Meeting, Seattle, 2002.
20 Lenke LG, Rinella A, Kim Y-J: Free hand thoracic pedicle screw placement. Semin Spine Surg
2002;14/1:4857.
21 Liljenqvist UR, Halm HF, Link TM: Pedicle screw instrumentation of the thoracic spine in idio
pathic scoliosis. Spine 1997;22:22392245.
22 McCormack BM, Benzel EC, Adams MS, et al: Anatomy of the thoracic pedicle. Neurosurgery
1995;37:303308.
23 OBrien MF, Lenke LG, Mardjetko S, et al: Pedicle morphology in thoracic adolescent idiopathic
scoliosis: Is pedicle fixation an anatomically viable technique? Spine 2000;25:22852293.
24 Panjabi MM, OHolleran JD, Crisco JJ, et al: Complexity of the thoracic spine pedicle anatomy.
Eur Spine J 1997;6:1924.
25 Polly DW, Belmont PJ, Klemme WR, Robinson M: In vivo accuracy of transpedicular thoracic
screws in patients with and without coronal-plane spinal deformities. Scoliosis Research Society
Annual Meeting, Cleveland, 2001.
Polly/Kuklo 106
dramroo
Haid RW Jr, Subach BR, Rodts GE Jr (eds): Advances in Spinal Stabilization.
Iain H. Kalfas
Section of Spinal Surgery, Department of Neurosurgery,
dramroo
Several studies have shown the unreliability of routine radiography in
assessing pedicle screw placement in the lumbosacral spine. The rate of pene
tration of the pedicle cortex by an inserted screw ranges from 21 to 31% in these
studies [6, 9, 20]. The disadvantage of these conventional radiographic tech
niques in orienting the spinal surgeon to the unexposed spinal anatomy is that
they display, at most, only two planar images. While the lateral view can be
relatively easy to assess, the anteroposterior or oblique view can be difficult to
interpret. For most screw fixation procedures, it is the position of the screw in
the axial plane that is most important. This plane best demonstrates the position
of the screw relative to the neural canal. Conventional intraoperative imaging
cannot provide this view. To assess the potential advantage of axial imaging for
screw placement, Steinmann et al. [19] used an image-based technique for pedi
cle screw placement that combined computed tomography (CT) axial images of
cadaver spine specimens with fluoroscopy. This study demonstrated an improve
ment in pedicle screw insertion accuracy with an error rate of only 5.5%.
Image-guided spinal navigation minimizes much of the guesswork associ
ated with complex spinal surgery. It allows for the intraoperative manipulation
of multiplanar CT images that can be oriented to any selected point in the
surgical field. Although it is not an intraoperative imaging device, it provides
the spinal surgeon with superior image data compared to conventional intraop
erative imaging technology (i.e. fluoroscopy). It improves the speed, accuracy
and precision of complex spinal surgery while, in most cases, eliminates the
need for cumbersome intraoperative fluoroscopy. This chapter will focus on its
use in the cervical spine.
Kalfas 108
dramroo
Fig. 1. Image-guided navigational workstation with infrared camera localizer system.
When positioned during surgery, the optical localizer emits infrared light
towards the operative field. A hand-held navigational probe mounted with a
fixed array of passive reflective spheres serves as the link between the surgeon
and the computer workstation (fig. 2). Alternatively, passive reflectors may be
attached to standard surgical instruments. The spacing and positioning of the
passive reflectors on each navigational probe or customized trackable surgical
instrument are known by the computer workstation. The infrared light that is
transmitted towards the operative field is reflected back to the optical localizer
by the passive reflectors. This information is relayed to the computer worksta
tion which can then calculate the precise location of the instrument tip in the
surgical field as well as the location of the anatomic point on which the instru
ment tip is resting.
The initial application of navigational principles to spinal surgery was not
intuitive. Early navigational technology applied to intracranial surgery used an
external frame mounted to the patients head to provide a point of reference to
link preoperative image data to intracranial anatomy. This was not practical for
spinal surgery. The current generation of intracranial navigational technology
uses reference markers or fiducials that are glued to the patients scalp prior to
imaging. However, the use of these surface-mounted fiducials for spinal navi
gation is not practical because of accuracy issues related to a greater degree of
skin movement over the spinal column [4, 5]. This is less of a problem with
intracranial applications because of the relatively fixed position of the overly
ing scalp to the attached fiducials.
The application of navigational technology to spinal surgery involves
using the rigid spinal anatomy itself as a frame of reference. Bone landmarks
on the exposed surface of the spinal column provide the points of reference
necessary for image-guided navigation. Specifically, any anatomic landmark
that can be identified intraoperatively as well as in the preoperative image data
set can be used as a reference point. The tip of a spinous or transverse process,
a facet joint or a prominent osteophyte can all serve as potential reference
points (fig. 3). Since each vertebra is a fixed, rigid body, the spatial relationship
of the selected registration points to the vertebral anatomy at a single spinal
level is not affected by changes in body position.
Two different registration techniques can be used for spinal navigation,
paired point registration and surface matching. Paired point registration involves
Kalfas 110
dramroo
selecting a series of corresponding points in a CT or magnetic resonance imag
ing data set and in the exposed spinal anatomy. The registration process is
performed immediately after surgical exposure and prior to any planned
decompressive procedure. This allows for the use of the spinous processes as
registration points.
A specific registration point in the CT image data set is selected by high
lighting it with the computer cursor. The tip of the probe is then placed on the
corresponding point in the surgical field and the reflective spheres on the probe
handle are aimed towards the camera. Infrared light from the camera is
reflected back allowing the spatial position of the probes tip to be identified.
This initial step of the registration process effectively links the point selected in
the image data with the point selected in the surgical field. When a minimum
of three such points are registered, the probe can be placed on any other point
in the surgical field and the corresponding point in the image data set will be
identified on the computer workstation.
Alternatively, a second registration technique called surface matching can be
used. This technique involves selecting multiple nondiscreet points only on the
exposed and debrided surface of the spine in the surgical field. This technique
does not require the preselection of points in the image set although several dis
creet points in both the image data set and in the surgical field are frequently
required to improve the accuracy of surface mapping. The positional information
of these points is transferred to the workstation and a topographic map of the
selected anatomy is created and matched to the patients image set [18].
Typically, paired point registration can be done more quickly than surface
mapping. The average time needed for paired point registration is 1015 s. The
time needed for surface mapping is much longer with difficult cases requiring
as much as 1015 min. With the need to perform several registration processes
during each surgery, this time difference can significantly impact the length of
the navigational procedure and the surgery itself [16].
The purpose of the registration process is to establish a precise spatial rela
tionship between the image space of the data with the physical space of the
patients corresponding surgical anatomy. If the patient is moved after registra
tion, this spatial relationship is distorted making the navigational information
inaccurate. This problem can be minimized by the optional use of a spinal
tracking device which consists of a separate set of passive reflectors mounted
on an instrument that can be attached to the exposed spinal anatomy (fig. 4).
The position of the reference frame can be tracked by the camera system.
Movement of the frame alerts the navigational system to any inadvertent move
ment of the spine. The system can then make correctional steps to keep the
registration process accurate and eliminate the need to repeat the registration
process. The disadvantage of using a tracking device is the added time needed
for its attachment to the spine, the need to maintain a line of sight between it
and the camera and the inconvenience of having to perform the procedure with
the device placed in the surgical field. It is particularly cumbersome when
image-guided navigation is used during cervical procedures.
Alternatively, image-guided spinal navigation can be performed without a
tracking device [12, 16]. This involves acknowledging the effect of patient
movement on the accuracy of image-guided navigation and maintaining a
reasonably stable patient position during the relatively short amount of time
needed (i.e. 1020 s) for the selection of each appropriate screw trajectory.
Patient movement can potentially occur with respiration, from the surgical team
leaning on the table or from a change of table position. Movement associated
with patient respiration is negligible and does not require any tracking even in
the thoracic spine. Although movement associated with leaning on the table or
repositioning the table or the patient will affect registration accuracy, it can be
easily avoided during the short navigational procedure. If inadvertent patient
movement does occur, the registration process can be repeated. Repeating the
registration process is easiest when using the shorter paired point technique as
opposed to the more time-consuming surface mapping technique.
When the registration process has been completed, the probe can be posi
tioned on any surface point in the surgical field and three separate reformatted
CT images centered on the corresponding point in the image data set are imme
diately presented on the workstation monitor. Each reformatted image is refer
enced to the long axis of the probe. If the probe is placed on the spinal anatomy
directly perpendicular to its long axis, the three images will be in the sagittal,
coronal and axial planes. A trajectory line representing the orientation of the
Kalfas 112
dramroo
long axis of the probe will overlay the sagittal and axial planes. A cursor repre
senting a cross section through the selected trajectory will overlay the coronal
plane. The insertional depth of the trajectory can be adjusted to correspond to
selected screw lengths. As the depth is adjusted, the specific coronal plane will
also adjust accordingly with the position of the cursor demonstrating the final
position of the tip of a screw placed at that depth along the selected trajectory.
As the probe is moved to another point in the surgical field, the reformatted
images as well as the position of the cursor and trajectory line will also change.
The planar orientation of the three reformatted images will also change as the
probes angle relative to the spinal axis changes. When the probes orientation
is not perpendicular to the long axis of the spine, the images displayed will be
in oblique or orthogonal planes. Regardless of the probes orientation, the
navigational workstation will provide the surgeon with a greater degree of
anatomic information than can be provided by any intraoperative imaging
technique.
The application of image-guided navigation to spinal surgery is directed by
the complexity of the procedure and, specifically, by the need to visualize the
unexposed spinal anatomy. Image-guided navigation can be used with or with
out standard intraoperative imaging techniques (i.e. fluoroscopy). In either case,
image-guided navigation provides the surgeon with an improved orientation to
the pertinent spinal anatomy, which subsequently facilitates the accuracy and
effectiveness of the procedure.
Clinical Applications
Navigational Technique
Image-guided navigation requires the acquisition of a preoperative CT scan
through the appropriate spinal segments to be instrumented. The image data is
then transferred to the computer workstation via optical disc or a high-speed data
link. If paired point registration is to be used, three to five reference points for
each spinal segment to be instrumented are selected and stored in the image data
set. For most cervical procedures, the camera can be positioned at the head of
the table with the navigation workstation positioned across from the surgeon.
If fluoroscopy is also used, it can be positioned next to the workstation (fig. 5).
Following a standard surgical exposure, either the paired point or surface
matching registration technique is performed. When the registration process
has been completed, most navigational workstations will calculate a registration
error (expressed in millimeters) that is directly dependent on the surgeons
registration technique. The error presented does not represent a linear error but
rather a volumetric calculation comparing the spacing of registration points in
the surgical field to the spacing of the corresponding points in the image data
set. This figure is, at best, a relative indicator of accuracy.
A more practical method of assuring registration accuracy is the verifica
tion step. This step is typically performed immediately after completing either
Kalfas 114
dramroo
registration process. The surgeon places the navigational probe on a discreet
landmark in the surgical field. With the navigational system now tracking the
movement and position of the probe, the trajectory line and cursor on the work
station screen will, if accurate registration has been achieved, move to the cor
responding point in the image data set (fig. 6a). If registration accuracy has not
been achieved, the cursor and trajectory line may rest on something other than
the point selected in the surgical field (fig. 6b). If this occurs to a significant
degree, the registration process needs to be repeated. This step is more of an
absolute indicator of registration accuracy and is a necessary step to perform
prior to proceeding with navigation.
6b
Kalfas 116
dramroo
presented. One of the images lies perpendicular to the sagittal image along the
selected trajectory. It represents an orthogonal view that lies approximately
midway between the coronal and axial planes through the spine. It demonstrates
a second view of the selected trajectory.
An additional view demonstrates an image oriented perpendicular to the
long axis of the probe and, therefore, the selected trajectory. A cursor superim
posed on this image can show the position of the screw tip along the selected
trajectory at millimetric increments. By scrolling through this image, the
proposed position of the screw along the selected trajectory can be assessed
along its entire path. While this planning technique does not assure safe screw
placement intraoperatively, it can preoperatively alert the surgeon to avoid
screw placement in patients with insufficient anatomy and to select an alternate
approach.
Intraoperatively, the patient is positioned and the posterior C12 complex
is exposed. A wire (cable) and bone graft stabilization procedure at the C12
level is performed prior to navigation and screw insertion. Performing this step
first minimizes any independent motion between C1 and C2 during navigation
and makes tap and screw insertion easier. If a reference frame is used, it is
typically attached to the spinous process of C2.
Following placement of the graft and cable, three to five registration points
are selected at the C2 level. It is not necessary to include registration points at
C1. Although the spatial relationship of C1 and C2 may change between the
preoperative scanned position and the intraoperative position, the ability of
image-guided navigation to facilitate accurate screw placement is not signifi
cantly affected. The technical difficulty of this procedure is the accurate pas
sage of the screw through the narrow pars interarticularis of C2. The lateral
mass of C1 is a relatively large target that can be easily reached provided there
is a reasonably acceptable realignment of C1 and C2 as well as an optimal posi
tioning of the screw within the appropriate C2 anatomy. While the relative posi
tion of C1 and C2 in both the preoperative image set and in the surgical field is
important, it is not critical enough to interfere with the process of image-guided
navigation.
Two separate stab incisions are made on either side of the midline at the
C7T1 level. A drill guide is placed through one of the stab incisions, passed
through the paravertebral musculature and into the operative field. A small
divot is drilled at the proposed entry site in order to provide for secure place
ment of the drill guide. The registration process is performed at the C2 level and
its accuracy confirmed using the verification step. The probe is passed through
the drill guide and, as its position is adjusted in the surgical field, the images
on the workstation screen will adjust accordingly to show the corresponding
trajectory in two separate planes and the projected location of the screw tip in
the third plane. Orientation to the correct screw position can be assessed rapidly
and accurately (fig. 7). Any errors in trajectory or entry point selection can be
determined and corrected by adjusting the position of the probe and the drill
guide through which it passes. When the correct screw insertion parameters
have been selected, the probe is removed from the drill guide and a drill
inserted. A hole is drilled along the selected trajectory, tapped and the appro
priate length screw inserted. The process is repeated on the opposite side.
Kalfas 118
dramroo
The purpose of the drill guide is to preserve the physical trajectory and
entry point information just acquired through the navigation of that pedicle. If a
drill guide is not used, it may be difficult to precisely position a drill or pedicle
probe on the same point and with the same trajectory previously conveyed by
the navigational probe after probe removal.
While image-guided navigation does not guarantee accurate screw place
ment, it does provide the surgeon with a greater degree of anatomical informa
tion than fluoroscopy alone. The addition of fluoroscopy to this navigational
technique provides the greatest degree of precision to the procedure. In this case
however, navigational technology significantly reduces the time of intraoperative
fluoroscopic usage as it is typically used only to help position the patient preop
eratively and as a final check of the selected trajectory in the sagittal plane imme
diately following the navigational step.
Kalfas 120
dramroo
The process is repeated for the other side. The heads of the screws are then
connected with two short rods.
Transoral Surgery
Transoral decompression of the upper cervical spine typically requires
intraoperative fluoroscopy to help maintain proper anatomic orientation during
the procedure. Although orientation in the sagittal plane is easy to obtain with
fluoroscopy, depth and medial-lateral orientation are more difficult to assess.
Image-guided technology can be used to orient the surgeon in multiple planes
during transoral surgery [16, 21].
Unlike other spinal applications of image guidance, discreet registration
points are not readily available during transoral surgery. In this setting,
surface-mounted markers (fiducials) are applied to the patient prior to
obtaining the preoperative CT. Typically, two fiducials are applied to the
mastoid processes and two are applied to the lateral orbital margins or to
both malar eminences. The nasal septum can also be used as an inherent
registration point.
The patient is positioned in a three-point head holder. The registration
process is performed prior to draping the patient using the surface-mounted
fiducials. Because the registration points will not be accessible during the
procedure, a reference frame is used for transoral navigation. This allows for
changes in patient positioning during surgery without the need to re-register.
The reference frame can be attached to the three-point head holder.
During the procedure, the probe can be placed into the site of the decom
pression. Reformatted sagittal, axial and coronal CT images are immediately
generated providing the surgeon with a precise orientation to the pertinent
surgical anatomy. In particular, orientation in the axial plane minimizes the risk
of lateral deviation towards the vertebral artery during the decompression
(fig. 10). If a posterior fixation is indicated following transoral decompression,
the same CT image data set can be used for C12 screw placement.
Fig. 11. Workstation screen demonstrating the use of image guidance to help localize
an osteoid osteoma within the lamina and articular pillar of C7.
Kalfas 122
dramroo
Fig. 12. Workstation screen demonstrating navigational information for the placement
of a screw into the pedicle of C7.
Fluoroscopic Navigation
Kalfas 124
dramroo
standard fluoroscopy (i.e. upper thoracic) will be difficult to image with
fluoroscopic navigation.
The early goals of image-guided spinal navigation were to improve the
surgeons orientation to the intraoperative spinal anatomy in a time- and cost-
efficient manner and to ultimately replace fluoroscopy. While earlier image-
guided systems were difficult to use intraoperatively, several advances have
made some systems much easier to use. Several years of clinical experience
have helped modify and improve navigational techniques. The use of paired
point registration and the optional use of a reference frame have both been
found to significantly reduce the difficulties of using image-guided technology
for spinal procedures. Advances in computer and localizer technology have also
contributed to an improved functionality of these systems. This improved ease
of use of the advanced image-guided systems coupled with superior accuracy,
image manipulation and orientation capabilities provides image-guided
technology with a clear advantage over any fluoroscopic-based technology.
Conclusion
References
1 Barnett GH, Kormos DW, Steiner CP, Weisenberger J: Use of a frameless, armless stereotactic
wand for brain tumor localization with two-dimensional and three-dimensional neuroimaging.
Neurosurgery 1993;33:674678.
2 Barnett GH, Kormos DW, Steiner CP, Weisenberger J: Intraoperative localization using an arm
less, frameless stereotactic wand. Technical note. J Neurosurg 1993;78:510514.
3 Bolger C, Wigfield C, Melkent T, Smith K: Frameless sterotaxy and anterior cervical surgery.
Comput Aided Surg 1999;4:322327.
4 Brodwater BK, Roberts DW, Nakajima T, Friets EM, Strohbehn JW: Extracranial application of
the frameless stereotactic operating microscope: Experience with lumbar spine. Neurosurgery
1993;32:209213.
5 Bryant JT, Reid JG, Smith BL, Stevenson JM: A method for determining vertebral body positions
in the sagittal plane using skin markers. Spine 1989;14:258265.
6 George DC, Krag MH, Johnson CC, Van Hal ME, Haugh LD, Grobler LJ: Hole preparation tech
nique for transpedicle screws: Effect on pull-out strength from human cadaveric vertebrae. Spine
1991;16:181184.
7 Foley KT, Simon DA, Rampersaud YR: Virtual fluoroscopy: Computer-assisted fluoroscopic
navigation. Spine 2001;26:347351.
8 Foley KT, Smith MM: Image-guided spine surgery. Neurosurg Clin N Am 1996;7/2:171186.
9 Gertzbein SD, Robbins SE: Accuracy of pedicle screw placement in vivo. Spine 1990;15:
1114.
10 Glossop ND, Hu RW, Randle JA: Computer-aided pedicle screw placement using frameless
sterotaxis. Spine 1996;21:20262034.
11 Harms J, Melcher R: Posterior C1C2 fusion with polyaxial screw and rod fixation. Spine 2001;
26:24672471.
12 Kalfas IH, Kormos DW, Murphy MA, McKenzie RL, Barnett GH, Bell GR, Steiner CP, Trimble
MB, Weisenberger JP: Application of frameless stereotaxy to pedicle screw fixation of the spine.
J Neurosurg 1995;83:641647.
13 Kalfas IH: Spinal surgery; in Barnett GH, Roberts DW, Maciunas RJ (eds): Image-Guided
Neurosurgery: Clinical Applications of Surgical Navigation. St Louis, Quality Medical Publishing,
1998, pp 117134.
14 Kalfas IH: Image-guided spinal navigation: Application to spinal metastasis; in Maciunas RJ (ed):
Advanced Techniques in Central Nervous System Metastasis. Lebanon, AANS Publications, 1998,
pp 245254.
15 Kalfas IH: Frameless stereotaxy assisted spinal surgery; in Renganchary SS (ed): Neurosurgery
Operative Color Atlas. Lebanon, AANS Publications, 2000, pp 123134.
16 Kalfas IH: Image-guided spinal navigation. Clin Neurosurg 1999;46:7088.
17 Murphy MA, McKenzie RL, Kormos DW, Kalfas IH: Frameless stereotaxis for the insertion of
lumbar pedicle screws: A technical note. J Clin Neurosci 1994;1/4:257260.
Kalfas 126
dramroo
18 Pellizzari CA, Levin DN, Chen GTY, Chen CT: Image registration based on anatomic surface
matching; in Maciunas RJ (ed): Interactive Image-Guided Neurosurgery. Park Ridge, American
Association of Neurological Surgeons, 1993, pp 4762.
19 Steinmann JC, Herkowitz HO, El-Kommos H, Wesolowski DP: Spinal pedicle fixation:
Confirmation of an image-based technique for screw placement. Spine 1993;18:18561861.
20 Weinstein JN, Spratt KF, Spengler D, Brick C, Reid S: Spinal pedicle fixation: Reliability and
validity of roentgenogram-based assessment and surgical factors on successful screw placement.
Spine 1988;13:10121018.
21 Welch WC, Subach BR, Pollack IF, Jacobs GB: Frameless sterotactic guidance for surgery of the
upper cervical spine. Neurosurgery 1997;40:958964.
b
Department of Neurosurgery, The Mayo Clinic, Scottsdale, Ariz., USA
Surgical Technique
The patient is positioned prone using a Mayfield head holder (OMI, Cincinnati, Ohio,
USA). The neck is kept neutral with the head in the military tuck position. The arms are
tucked at the sides and the shoulders retracted caudally using tape. A midline incision is
made extending from the inion to the spine of C3 if atlantoaxial fixation is planned. The
incision is extended inferiorly as indicated by the planned procedure. A bilateral sub
periosteal dissection of the paraspinal musculature is performed to expose the lateral margins
of the facet joints at the C2-C3 level. Dissection is continued laterally over the dorsal arch
of C1, exposing the vertebral artery in the vertebral groove on the C1 arch. Bipolar cautery
and hemostatic agents such as gelfoam and fibrillar collagen are used to control bleeding
from the perivertebral venous plexus. The C2 nerve root is identified and mobilized inferiorly.
The lateral mass of C1 inferior to the C1 arch is exposed. The medial wall of the lateral mass
is identified using a forward angle curette to identify the medial limit of screw placement.
The medial aspect of the transverse foramen can also be identified and serves as the lateral
limit for screw placement. The entry point for screw placement is identified 35 mm lateral to
the medial wall of the lateral mass, at the junction of the lateral mass and inferior aspect of
the C1 arch (fig. 1). The entry point may be varied depending on the distance between the
medial wall of the lateral mass and the C1 transverse foramen. A high speed drill with
a 3-mm round burr is used to remove a small portion of the inferior aspect of the C1 arch
overlying the entry point, to create a recess for the screw head and plate or rod
(fig. 2a). An assistant retracts the C2 nerve inferiorly and protects the vertebral artery with
Penfield dissectors or similar instruments during drilling and screw placement. Using fluo
roscopy or image guidance a 3-mm drill bit and guide are used to drill a hole with 1015
of medial angulation to penetrate the anterior cortex of C1 (fig. 2b, 3). On lateral fluoros
copic imaging the drill is aimed toward the anterior tubercle of C1, so that the drill pene
trates the ventral cortex of the lateral mass midway between the superior and inferior facets
of C1 (fig. 2c, 4). The hole is tapped with a 3.5-mm tap. If lateral mass plates are used, an
appropriate-sized plate is selected and contoured, after which a 3.5-mm screw is placed
through the plate (fig. 5). Caudal fixation points are then finalized. If a polyaxial screw-rod
system is used, all screws are placed after which an appropriate sized and contoured rod is
secured (fig. 2d). In both cases an appropriate screw length is selected to achieve bicortical
fixation.
Once instrumentation placement is complete, decompression is performed if necessary.
Finally, arthrodesis is performed. Posterior arthrodesis with sublaminar cable and inter
spinous bicortical autograft is preferred if the laminae of C1 and C2 are preserved.
Otherwise, lateral arthrodesis is performed by carefully decorticating the exposed surfaces
of the C1-C2 joints with a high-speed drill, and then packing cancellous iliac crest autograft
over these joints. A Hemovac drain is placed prior to wound closure.
Results
Seventeen C1 lateral mass screws were placed in 8 patients (table 1). These
screws were incorporated into several different constructs using lateral mass
plates (Axis, Sofamor Danek) or a polyaxial screw-rod system (Vertex, Sofamor
Danek) to achieve atlantocervical fixation in 9 patients and occipitocervical
fixation in 1 patient. There were no intraoperative complications and no vertebral
artery injuries. One patient died on postoperative day 9 from complications of
aspiration pneumonia. The remaining patients were immediately mobilized post
operatively in hard cervical collars worn for 3 months. Immediate rigid fixation
was achieved in all patients. Follow-up ranged from 9 days to 18 months (mean
6.6 months). Osseous fusion was documented in 2 patients on 9- and 18-month
Fiore/Birch/Haid 130
dramroo
a b
c d
Fig. 2. a Recess for the screw head is created on the inferior aspect of the C1 arch. b Axial
drawing shows medial screw angulation and relationship to transverse foramina. c Lateral view
of C1-C2 construct with C1 lateral mass screw, C2 pedicle screw, and plate, demonstrating screw
trajectory. d Posterior view of completed C1-C2 construct using polyaxial screw and rod system.
Fiore/Birch/Haid 132
dramroo
Table 1. Case representations
C1 Lateral Mass Fixation
1 16/F Neck pain, Irreducible type II odontoid Bilateral C1 LMS, C2 pars 6 months F/E films stable,
neurologically fracture screws, polyaxial screw/rod neurologically
intact construct; interspinous intact
cable/autograft
2 68/F Neck pain Old type II odontoid fracture, Bilateral C1 LMS, C2 pars 4 months F/E films stable,
nonunion, mobile on F/E films screws, polyaxial screw/rod clinically improved
construct; interspinous
cable/autograft
3 81/M Hand numbness, Transverse ligament cyst, C1 laminectomy, unilateral C1 3 months Rod
dramroo
7 34/M Neck pain, Irreducible type III odontoid Bilateral C1, C3 LMS, C2 pars 9 months Osseous fusion,
neurologically fracture screws, plate construct; F/E films stable,
intact interspinous cable/autograft neurologically
intact
8 72/F Hand weakness, Congenitally narrow canal at C1 laminectomy; bilateral C1, 3 months F/E films stable,
myelopathy C1, cervicomedullary C3 LMS, plate construct; C2 clinically stable
compression, C1-C2 sublaminar cables; lateral
subluxation, bilateral medial autograft arthrodesis
VAs
dramroo
9 69/F Neck pain, Leiomyosarcoma metastasis to Tumor resection; bilateral C1, 16 months F/E films stable,
neurologically R C2 pars, medial L VA C3, C4 LMS, L C2 pars screw, neurologically
intact plate construct; lateral autograft intact, died from
arthrodesis diffuse
metastases
10 74/M R hemiparesis, Metastatic colon cancer, Occipitocervical fusion to C5 9 days Died from
neck pain pathologic C2 burst fracture, with polyaxial screw/rod pneumonia
spinal cord compression system, bilateral C1 LMS
LMS Lateral mass screw, TAS transarticular screw, F/E flexion/extension, VA vertebral artery.
134
Fig. 6. Patient 1. Preoperative lateral cervical radiograph demonstrating anteriorly dis
placed type II odontoid fracture.
Discussion
indications. In our experience, the most common indication for the use of C1 lat
eral mass screws is atlantoaxial instability. Although a variety of techniques exist
to treat atlantoaxial instability, certain anatomic factors may preclude their appli
cation in specific situations. C1-C2 interspinous fusion techniques using either
sublaminar cables or interlaminar clamps in combination with iliac crest auto
graft require the presence of intact posterior elements. These techniques cannot
be applied when the C1 arch or C2 laminae have been disrupted by trauma, neo
plasm, or other pathologic processes, or when resection of these elements is nec
essary to achieve neural decompression. C1-C2 transarticular screw fixation is
likewise precluded by a variety of factors. In up to 20% of patients, a medially
located or high-riding vertebral artery will preclude safe passage of C1-C2
transarticular screws unilaterally. In 3% of patients, vertebral artery anatomy will
preclude passage of screws bilaterally [9, 10]. Irreducible C1-C2 subluxation will
likewise preclude optimal placement of C1-C2 transarticular screws. In this case,
a screw trajectory traversing the articular surfaces of C1 and C2 cannot be
achieved. Severe cervicothoracic kyphosis may preclude C1-C2 transarticular
screw placement by obstructing the trajectory of the instruments used to insert
the screws. Destruction or erosion of the osseous substrate for screw fixation by
trauma, neoplasm, or other pathologic processes will likewise preclude transar
ticular screw placement. In these situations occipitocervical fusion may be con
sidered as an alternative means to treat atlantoaxial instability. Occipitocervical
fusion may be avoided by using C1 lateral mass screws to achieve atlantocervi
cal fixation. By avoiding occipitocervical fixation, patients avoid the risk of
intracranial bleeding which may occur with placement of occipital hardware
[11]. Additionally, range of motion at the atlantooccipital joint is maintained,
Fiore/Birch/Haid 136
dramroo
reducing morbidity from craniocervical malalignment that may occur following
occipitocervical fusion. Clinical studies have also suggested that avoidance of
occipitocervical fusion may decrease the incidence of delayed subaxial subluxa
tion [12, 13]. In this series we achieved atlantocervical fixation in 7 patients who
demonstrated various anatomic characteristics that precluded traditional methods
of atlantoaxial fixation. These patients were all mobilized in hard cervical collars,
avoiding postoperative halo vest immobilization.
It is likely that C1 lateral mass screws will also prove to be an extremely
useful technique for occipitocervical fixation. C1 lateral mass screws provide
additional fixation points for occipitocervical constructs, possibly increasing
resistance to construct failure. This additional construct integrity is achieved
without fusing additional cervical levels, thus preserving cervical motion
segments. In the one patient in this series who underwent occipitocervical
fixation, we were able to achieve solid C1 fixation and integration into the
occipitocervical construct using C1 lateral mass screws. As the use of polyax
ial screw-rod systems for occipitocervical fixation becomes more widespread,
we anticipate that C1 lateral mass screws will be used more frequently, since the
contourable rods used in these systems will allow C1 screws to be easily
incorporated into occipitocervical constructs.
In 6 of the 9 patients in this series who underwent atlantocervical fixation,
constructs using C1 lateral mass screws were supplemented with a posterior
C1-C2 fusion using sublaminar cable and interspinous autograft. In recent case
series, Dickman et al. [4] reported an 86% fusion rate after interspinous fusion
with cables and autograft, while Farey et al. [5] reported a 58% fusion rate. In two
smaller series, fusion rates of 100% were achieved using the Brooks method of
interspinous fusion, but all patients were immobilized in a halo vest for 3 months
[14, 15]. It is not clear from this series whether C1 lateral mass screw constructs
will increase fusion rates when applied in addition to interspinous fusion tech
niques, but it seems likely that the additional rigidity conferred by these constructs
should result in improved outcomes. The ability of unilateral C1 lateral mass
screw constructs to increase fusion rates when applied together with contralateral
C1-C2 transarticular screws is also unclear. Song et al. [16] reported a 95% fusion
rate after unilateral transarticular screw placement combined with posterior inter
spinous fusion in a group of patients with high-riding vertebral arteries. In the
present series, 1 patient had a unilateral C1 lateral mass screw construct in com
bination with a contralateral transarticular screw and interspinous fusion. Again,
it seems likely that the supplemental fixation provided by the C1 lateral mass
screw construct will increase rigidity and result in higher fusion rates.
It is also unclear whether C1 lateral mass screw constructs can be used as
a stand-alone method for achieving atlantocervical fusion in the absence of
interspinous fusion or unilateral transarticular screw fixation. Harms and
Fiore/Birch/Haid 138
dramroo
threads along the entire shaft. We did not observe any cases of occipital
neuralgia or screw breakage. These results indicate that standard screws may be
used at C1. We believe the risk of greater occipital nerve irritation is small as
long as there is adequate space caudal to the C1 screw for passage of the nerve.
In 1 patient not included in this series, placement of C1 lateral mass screws was
planned. However, intraoperatively the C2 nerve roots were found to be much
larger than usual, occupying the entire space between the inferior aspect of the
C1 dorsal arch and the superior aspect of the C2 pars. In this case, we elected
not to place C1 screws, since the risk of C2 irritation was unacceptably high.
In this case the alternative would be to place C1 screws directly into the dorsal
aspect of the C1 arch, rather than into the inferior surface of the arch. This
would place the screw shafts away from the C2 nerve roots. However, this can
only be considered when the rostrocaudal dimension of the C1 arch is large
enough to accommodate a screw. In addition, the vertebral artery in the C1
groove must be retracted rostrally during drilling, increasing the risk of embolic
complications or direct injury to the vertebral artery by the drill, retractor, or
other instruments.
The risk of vertebral artery injury must always be assessed when place
ment of lateral mass screws or transarticular screws is planned. In this small
case series, there were no vertebral artery injuries. To minimize this risk,
preoperative assessment of the path of the vertebral artery using CT scanning
is mandatory prior to placement of C1 lateral mass screws. Magnetic resonance
angiography or catheter angiography may be performed to provide additional
information concerning the path and patency of the vertebral arteries, although
in our experience we have not found this to be necessary. The surgeon must note
that the trajectory of the C1 lateral mass screw is very different from that of
lateral mass screws placed in the subaxial cervical spine. Particularly important
is that the C1 screw is placed with a slight medial angulation to avoid the
vertebral artery laterally and the spinal canal medially. We consider the use of
intraoperative fluoroscopy or CT-based image guidance mandatory to safely
place C1 lateral mass screws. Fluoroscopy allows safe placement of bicortical
screws under direct visualization, while CT-based image guidance provides
additional three-dimensional information about the vertebral artery and spinal
canal. Virtual fluoroscopy may also prove to be a useful adjunct to screw
placement.
Conclusion
References
1 Fiore AJ, Haid RW, Rodts GE, Subach BR, Mummaneni PV, Riedel CJ, Birch BD: Atlantal lateral
mass screws for posterior spinal reconstruction: Technical note and case series. Neurosurg Focus
2002:12/1:article 5.
2 Harms J, Melcher RP: Posterior C1-C2 fusion with polyaxial screw and rod fixation. Spine
2001;26:24672471.
3 Stokes JK, Villavicencio AT, Liu PC, Bray RS, Johnson JP: Posterior atlantoaxial stabilization:
New alternative to C12 transarticular screws. Neurosurg Focus 2002;12/1:article 6.
4 Dickman CA, Sonntag VK, Papadopoulos SM, Hadley MN: The interspinous method of posterior
atlantoaxial arthrodesis. J Neurosurg 1991;74:190198.
5 Farey ID, Nadkarni S, Smith N: Modified Gallie technique versus transarticular screw fixation in
C1-C2 fusion. Clin Orthop 1999;35:126135.
6 Dickman CA, Sonntag VK: Posterior C1-C2 transarticular screw fixation for atlantoaxial
arthrodesis. Neurosurgery 1998;43:275281.
7 Haid RW, Subach BR, McLaughlin MR, Rodts GE, Wahlig JB: C1-C2 transarticular screw
fixation for atlantoaxial instability: A 6-year experience. Neurosurgery 2001;49:6570.
8 Moskovich R, Crockard HA: Atlantoaxial arthrodesis using interlaminar clamps. Spine
1992;17:261267.
9 Madawi AA, Casey AT, Solanki GA, Tuite G, Veres R, Crockard HA: Radiological and anatomi
cal evaluation of the atlantoaxial transarticular screw fixation technique. J Neurosurg
1997;86:961968.
10 Paramore CG, Dickman CA, et al: The anatomic suitability of the C1-2 complex for transarticular
screw fixation. J Neurosurg 1996;85:221224.
11 Vale FL, Oliver M, Cahill DW: Rigid occipitocervical fusion. J Neurosurg 1997;91(suppl 2):144150.
12 Clark CR, Goetz DD, Menezes AH: Arthrodesis of the cervical spine in rheumatoid arthritis.
J Bone Joint Surg Am 1989;71:381392.
Fiore/Birch/Haid 140
dramroo
13 Kraus DR, Peppelman WC, Agarwal AK, DeLeeuw HW, Donaldson WF: Incidence of subaxial
subluxation in patients with generalized rheumatoid arthritis who had previous occipital cervical
fusions. Spine 1991;16(suppl):486489.
14 Boden SD, Dodge LD, Bohlman HH, Rechtine GR: Rheumatoid arthritis of the cervical spine.
A long-term analysis with predictors of paralysis and recovery. J Bone Joint Surg Am
1993;75:12821297.
15 McCarron RF, Robertson WW: Brooks fusion for atlantoaxial instability in rheumatoid arthritis.
South Med J 1988;81:474476.
16 Song GS, Theodore N, et al: Unilateral posterior atlantoaxial transarticular screw fixation.
J Neurosurg 1997;87:851855.
17 Lynch JJ, Crawford NR, Chamberlain RH, Bartolomei JC, Sonntag VK: Biomechanics of lateral
mass/pedicle screw fixation at C1-2. Proceedings of the 2002 Annual Meeting of the American
Association of Neurological Surgeons, Chicago, 2002.
Cervical Laminoplasty
Adrian T.H. Caseya,b, H. Alan Crockarda
a
Victor Horsley Department of Neurosurgery, National Hospital for Neurology
and Neurosurgery, London, and
b
Spinal Surgery Unit, The Royal National Orthopaedic Hospital, Stanmore, UK
dramroo
Table 1. Indications for expansive cervical laminoplasty
This method has the advantage of technical simplicity and allows for postoper
ative magnetic resonance imaging because the use of stainless steel implants is
avoided. It has been used in the authors departments in more than 300 cases
now, with good short- and long-term results. The technique is no longer limited
to ossification of the posterior longitudinal ligament, which is rare in
Caucasians. Its most frequent use is now for multilevel cervical spondylotic
myelopathy associated with varying degrees of constitutional canal stenosis.
The indications and contraindications are listed in tables 1 and 2.
Kyphosis is a contraindication to laminectomy [29] and probably lamino
plasty [30, 31].
There are several technical variations. The two main differences are
whether the opening is in the midline (French door) or to one side (open door).
Then there are differences in how to keep the door open. Initially the techniques
were quite cumbersome and involved suturing or wiring the bony posterior
elements to muscle. Inevitably they did not always keep the door as open as it
may have been originally at the time of surgery. The Queen Square technique
uses titanium miniplates with no bone graft to keep the door open. In our expe
rience this has been a simple and reliable technique. Alternative techniques
have used ceramic spacers or bone graft to keep the doors open.
Three types of Z plasty may be performed: on the lamina using the method
of Hattori as reported by Oyama et al. [32], between each lamina using the
reciprocal method of Tomimura and Morizono [33] and between two segmen
tal laminae using the Chiba University technique [34]. The variety of reported
techniques are illustrated in figure 1.
Laminoplasty 143
dramroo
Itoh 1984 Koyama 1985 Lin 1986
Hattori 1989
Casey/Crockard 144
dramroo
Tomita et al. have [3] championed the use of their thread wire saw to
achieve the opening. This is similar to a very fine Gigli saw. It was developed
for en bloc vertebrectomy. This is a clever technical innovation, however it does
require sublaminar passage of the wire. This is very much finer than sublami
nar wires and indeed cables which have been implicated in neurological deteri
oration. The majority of the other techniques require a high-speed drill.
Laminoplasty 145
dramroo
a b c
Fig. 2. Operative sequence showing preparation of the bilateral channels for the hinge
side (right) and opening side (left) of the laminoplasty (a), mobilization and rotation of the
posterior elements (b), and stabilization of the open-door laminoplasty with titanium
miniplates (c) [modified from 22].
Casey/Crockard 146
dramroo
Fig. 3. Schematic diagram showing the orientation of the titanium miniplates in a
C3C6 laminoplasty and adjacent anatomic structures.
brought into contact as the hinge side trough is closed during elevation and
rotation of the posterior elements into the open position. This is analogous to a
green stick fracture. The morbidity associated with harvesting bone graft is
avoided. A soft collar is used to facilitate patient comfort while mobilizing
during the first few days after surgery. No other external orthosis is used after
surgery.
Discussion
Laminoplasty 147
dramroo
Nonetheless there is an intellectual reluctance to perform a multilevel
trench procedure with fusion in a young patient. The incidence of complications
for anterior multilevel corpectomy has been reported to be high even in expert
hands. Saunders et al. [37] did a retrospective analysis of 31 cases of cervical
spondylotic myelopathy treated by four-level subaxial cervical corpectomy.
Three patients died within 3 weeks of surgery (9.7%). Delayed radiculopathy
occurred in 4 patients after surgery, 3 had acute graft complications, and 1 had
pseudomeningocoele, resulting in a morbidity rate of 25.8%. There were no
cases of infection or increasing myelopathy. In another series by these authors,
on 40 cases of cervical corpectomy, they reported a perioperative complication
rate of 47.5%, with a 7.5% incidence of persistent sequelae [3739]. Fessler
et al. [40] have reported their extensive experience of cervical corpectomy in a
retrospective series of 93 cases over 10 years with a lower complication rate.
In another more recent series Edwards et al. [41] have attempted to compare the
neurological outcome and complications of cervical corpectomy and cervical
laminoplasty. Medical records of all patients treated for multilevel cervical
myelopathy with either multilevel corpectomy or laminoplasty between 1994
and 1999 at the Emory Spine Center were reviewed. From a pool of 38 patients
meeting stringent inclusion and exclusion criteria, 13 patients who underwent
multilevel corpectomy were blindly matched with 13 patients who underwent
laminoplasty based on known prognostic criteria. Improvement in function
averaged 1.6 Nurick grades after laminoplasty and 0.9 grades after multilevel
corpectomy (p 0.05). Subjective improvements in strength, dexterity, sensa
tion, pain, and gait were similar for the two operations. The prevalence of axial
discomfort at the latest follow-up was the same for each cohort, but the anal
gesic requirements tended to be greater for patients who underwent multilevel
corpectomy. This is the opposite finding to the larger study of Hosono et al. [42]
on pain. Sagittal motion from C2 to C7 decreased by 57% after multilevel cor
pectomy and by 38% after laminoplasty. One complication (C6C7 herniated
nucleus pulposus requiring anterior discectomy with fusion) occurred in the
laminoplasty group [41]. Multilevel corpectomy complications included the
progression of myelopathy, non-union, persistent dysphagia, persistent dyspho
nia, and subjacent motion segment ankylosis.
An alternative posterior decompressive procedure to laminoplasty is cervi
cal laminectomy with posterior fixation/fusion. Today this would be performed
using the lateral mass screw/rod system. This will also prevent postoperative
kyphus. It will more reliably immobilize the spine. Adams and Logue [43, 44]
have shown that one of the reasons for delayed deterioration following cervical
laminectomy is hypermobility. Screw/rod fixation is therefore an attractive
option. However the extra rigidity is probably not required as Herkowitz
[45, 46] concluded from his biomechanical study that stability of the cervical
Casey/Crockard 148
dramroo
spine after laminoplasty was not significantly different from that of the intact
control. Laminoplasty affords some rigidity, but still preserves motion [47]. The
long-term effects of laminoplasty on cervical movement and alignment were
investigated by radiography and CT scans in a study of 56 patients with multi-
segmental myelopathy who had undergone a C3 to C7 open-door laminoplasty.
Follow-up averaged 5.8 years. Satisfactory neurological improvement occurred
in 73%. Cervical flexion decreased by 35% and extension by 57%; the decrease
of both movements was statistically significant. Decreased vertebral slip as well
as slightly reduced lordosis was seen after operation.
Cervical laminectomy and laminoplasty have been compared in a retrospec
tive study [48]. This is another study from Emory, with similar design principles
to the corpectomy/laminoplasty study described above (an independent matched
cohort analysis), involving 13 patients in each arm. Both objective improvement in
patient function (Nurick score) and the number of patients reporting subjective
improvement in strength, dexterity, sensation, pain, and gait tended to be greater in
the laminoplasty cohort [48]. Whereas no complications occurred in the lamino
plasty cohort, there were 14 complications in 9 patients that underwent laminec
tomy with fusion. Complications included progression of myelopathy, non-union,
instrumentation failure, development of a significant kyphotic alignment, persis
tent bone graft harvest site pain, subjacent degeneration requiring reoperation, and
deep infection. The marked difference in complications and functional improve
ment between these matched cohorts suggests that laminoplasty may be preferable
to laminectomy with fusion, as a posterior procedure for multilevel cervical
myelopathy [48]. Similar findings were found in a less well-controlled study by
Herkowitz [49]. In this retrospective study he compared the results and complica
tions of 45 patients with at least a 2-year follow-up, who had undergone anterior
fusion, cervical laminectomy, or cervical laminoplasty for the surgical manage
ment of multiple level cervical radiculopathy due to cervical spondylosis. Eighteen
patients (58 levels) underwent anterior fusion, 12 patients (38 levels) had a cervi
cal laminectomy, and 15 patients (57 levels) underwent a cervical laminoplasty. In
another study by Baisden et al. [50], radiographic and biomechanical results in the
goat model revealed that laminoplasty was superior to laminectomy in maintain
ing cervical alignment and preventing postoperative spinal deformities. Quite how
this relates to humans is debatable.
Complications
Laminoplasty 149
dramroo
approximately 510% of the patients in the series of Hirabayashi et al. [35]
of 350 patients although most complications resolve spontaneously within 2
years. Of 365 patients who had undergone laminoplasty, 20 patients (5.5%)
developed postoperative radiculopathy. Using data from postoperative com
puted tomography scans and other sources, these patients were compared with
211 patients with no radiculopathy, who had undergone laminoplasty during the
same period, to identify risk factors related to patient characteristics and surgi
cal techniques. Of various risk factors studied, the narrowest level of the spinal
canal, preoperative symptomatic severity, flatness of the spinal cord assessed by
computed tomography myelopathy at C4C5, cervical curvature, anterior pro
trusion of the superior articular process as assessed by computed tomography
scan, laterality of the osteophytes, and ossification of the posterior longitudinal
ligament could not significantly discriminate between patients with and with
out postoperative radiculopathy. The angle of lamina as measured by using
computed tomography scans obtained after expansion in the patients with
radiculopathy was greater on both the opened and hinged sides and was signif
icantly greater than the angle in patients without radiculopathy (p 0.05). The
incidence of radiculopathy on both the opened and hinged sides was signifi
cantly higher in patients in whom the bony gutter had been cut on the lateral
side of the medial aspect of the zygapophyseal joint. An alternative theory is
that too radical a decompression allows slumping backwards of the spinal cord,
putting traction on the anatomically vulnerable C5 nerve root. This is the theory
espoused for C5 radiculopathy following the trench corpectomy procedure.
Here it now recommended limiting the decompression to 15 mm from right to
left. Friction heat generated by drilling on the open and hinge sides, traumatic
use of Kerrison rongeurs, and a drop of the hinge into the canal are also by
some considered as causes of such injury. However, these types of trauma dur
ing the operation are likely to damage the posterior root rather than the anterior
root; therefore, the sensory disturbance is expected to be stronger. Nevertheless,
in most cases, sensory disturbance at C5 or C6 was absent. This lends credence
to the tethering action on the anterior root [35].
Pain
There is an increasing recognition that this is quite a painful procedure in
the short term, mainly with pain in the trapezius region. In the long run a fair
number of patients experience neck pain. This has been studied by Hosono
et al. [42]. Ninety-eight patients had surgery for their disability secondary to
cervical spondylotic myelopathy. Of those patients, 72 had laminoplasty and 26
had anterior interbody fusion. The presence or absence of axial symptoms was
investigated before and after surgery. The duration, severity, and laterality of
symptoms were also recorded. The prevalence of postoperative axial symptoms
Casey/Crockard 150
dramroo
was significantly higher after laminoplasty than after anterior fusion (60 vs.
19%; p 0.05). In 18 patients (25%) from the laminoplasty group, the chief
complaints after surgery were related to axial symptoms for more than 3 months,
whereas in the anterior fusion group, no patient reported having such severe
pain after surgery. In this group shoulder pain developed exclusively on the
hinged side.
In conclusion, open door expansive laminoplasty is a versatile, easy and
effective method for achieving multilevel decompression of the cervical spine
affected by ossification of the posterior longitudinal ligament or cervical
spondylosis [51].
References
1 Banerji D, Acharya R, Behari S, Chhabra DK, Jain VK: Corpectomy for multi-level cervical
spondylosis and ossification of the posterior longitudinal ligament. Neurosurg Rev 1997;20/1:
2531.
2 Epstein NE: Reoperation rates for acute graft extrusion and pseudarthrosis after one-level anterior
corpectomy and fusion with and without plate instrumentation: Etiology and corrective manage
ment. Surg Neurol 2001;56/2:7381.
3 Tomita K, Kawahara N, Toribatake Y, Heller JG: Expansive midline T-saw laminoplasty (modified
spinous process-splitting) for the management of cervical myelopathy. Spine 1998;23/1:3237.
4 Nakano N, Nakano T: Clinical results following enlargement of the cervical spinal canal by means
of laminoplasty. Nippon Seikeigeka Gakkai Zasshi 1988;62:11391147.
5 Morimoto T, Uranishi R, Nakase H, Kawaguchi S, Hoshido T, Sakaki T: Extensive cervical
laminoplasty for patients with long segment OPLL in the cervical spine: An alternative to the ante
rior approach. J Clin Neurosci 2000;7/3:217222.
6 Kojima T, Waga S, Kubo Y, Kanamaru K, Shimosaka S, Shimizu T: Anterior cervical vertebrec
tomy and interbody fusion for multi-level spondylosis and ossification of the posterior longitudi
nal ligament. Neurosurgery 1989;24:864872.
7 Onari K, Akiyama N, Kondo S, Toguchi A, Mihara H, Tsuchiya T: Long-term follow-up results of
anterior interbody fusion applied for cervical myelopathy due to ossification of the posterior
longitudinal ligament. Spine 2001;26:488493.
8 Sridhar K, Ramamurthi R, Vasudevan MC, Ramamurthi B: Surgery for ossification of the poste
rior longitudinal ligament of the cervical spine. Neurol India 2001;49/2:116123.
9 Epstein NE: Identification of ossification of the posterior longitudinal ligament extending through
the dura on preoperative computed tomographic examinations of the cervical spine. Spine 2001;
26/2:182186.
10 Shinomiya K, Okamoto A, Kamikozuru M, Furuya K, Yamaura I: An analysis of failures in pri
mary cervical anterior spinal cord decompression and fusion. J Spinal Disord 1993;6/4:277288.
11 Callahan RA, Johnson RM, Margolis RN, Keggi KJ, Albright JA, Southwick WO: Cervical facet
fusion for control of instability following laminectomy. J Bone Joint Surg Am 1977;59:9911002.
12 Fager CA: Laminectomy and kyphotic deformity. J Neurosurg 2001;95(suppl 1):157158.
13 Herman JM, Sonntag VK: Cervical corpectomy and plate fixation for postlaminectomy kyphosis.
J Neurosurg 1994;80:963970.
14 Zdeblick TA, Bohlman HH: Cervical kyphosis and myelopathy. Treatment by anterior corpectomy
and strut-grafting. J Bone Joint Surg Am 1989;71/2:170182.
15 Yonenobu K, Hosono N, Iwasaki M, Asano M, Ono K: Neurologic complications of surgery for
cervical compression myelopathy. Spine 1991;16:12771282.
16 Skowronski J, Bielecki M: The results of laminectomy and laminoplasty in cervical myeloradicu
lopathy. Rocz Akad Med Bialymst 1992;37:7173.
Laminoplasty 151
dramroo
17 Yonenobu K, Wada E, Suzuki S, Kanazawa A: The dorsal approach in degeneratively changed cer
vical spine. Orthopde 1996;25:533541.
18 Kawai S, Sunago K, Doi K, Saika M, Taguchi T: Cervical laminoplasty (Hattoris method).
Procedure and follow-up results. Spine 1988;13:12451250.
19 Lee TT, Manzano GR, Green BA: Modified open-door cervical expansive laminoplasty for spondy
lotic myelopathy: Operative technique, outcome, and predictors for gait improvement. J Neurosurg
1997;86/1:6468.
20 Ishibashi K: Expansive laminoplasty by sagittal splitting of the spinous process for cervical
myelopathy: Correlation of clinical results with morphological changes in the cervical spine.
Kurume Med J 2000;47/2:135145.
21 Morimoto T, Yamada T, Okumura Y, Kakizaki T, Kawaguchi S, Hiramatsu K, et al: Expanding
laminoplasty for cervical myelopathy-spinous process roofing technique. Acta Neurochir 1996;
138:720725.
22 OBrien MF, Peterson D, Casey AT, Crockard HA: A novel technique for laminoplasty augmenta
tion of spinal canal area using titanium miniplate stabilization. A computerized morphometric
analysis. Spine 1996;21:474484.
23 Gillett GR, Erasmus AM, Lind CR: CG-clip expansive open-door laminoplasty: A technical note.
Br J Neurosurg 1999;13:405408.
24 Hirabayashi K, Bohlman HH: Multilevel cervical spondylosis. Laminoplasty versus anterior
decompression. Spine 1995;20:17321734.
25 Wang JM, Roh KJ, Kim DJ, Kim DW: A new method of stabilising the elevated laminae in open-
door laminoplasty using an anchor system. J Bone Joint Surg Br 1998;80:10051008.
26 Hirabayashi K: Expansive open-door laminoplasty for cervical spondylotic myelopathy. Jpn J
Surg 1978;32:11591163.
27 Kirita Y: Posterior decompression for cervical spondylosis and ossification of the posterior longi
tudinal ligament. Shujutsu 1976;30:287302.
28 Nakano K, Harata S, Suetsuna F, Araki T, Itoh J: Spinous process-splitting laminoplasty using
hydroxyapatite spinous process spacer. Spine 1992;17(suppl 3):S41S43.
29 Batzdorf U, Batzdorff A: Analysis of cervical spine curvature in patients with cervical spondylo
sis. Neurosurgery 1988;22:827836.
30 Matsunaga S, Sakou T, Nakanisi K: Analysis of the cervical spine alignment following lamino
plasty and laminectomy. Spinal Cord 1999;37/1:2024.
31 Fujimura Y, Nishi Y: Atrophy of the nuchal muscle and change in cervical curvature after expan
sive open-door laminoplasty. Arch Orthop Trauma Surg 1996;115/34:203205.
32 Oyama M, Hattori S, Noriwaki N: A new method of cervical laminectomy. Chubu Nippon
Seikeigeka Gakkai Zasshi 1984;16:792794.
33 Tomimura KS, Morizono Y: Osteoplastic enlargement of the cervical canal for cervical spondylo
sis. Rinsho Seikeigeka 1984;19:491497.
34 Watanabe TI, Goto S: Expansive laminoplasty (Chiba modification) for cervical myelopathy.
Shujutsu 1987;41:519527.
35 Hirabayashi K, Toyama Y, Chiba K: Expansive laminoplasty for myelopathy in ossification of the
longitudinal ligament. Clin Orthop 1999;359:3548.
36 Hilibrand AS, Carlson GD, Palumbo MA, Jones PK, Bohlman HH: Radiculopathy and myelopa
thy at segments adjacent to the site of a previous anterior cervical arthrodesis. J Bone Joint Surg
Am 1999;81:519528.
37 Saunders RL, Pikus HJ, Ball P: Four-level cervical corpectomy. Spine 1998;23:24552461.
38 Saunders RL, Bernini PM, Shirreffs TG Jr, Reeves AG: Central corpectomy for cervical spondy
lotic myelopathy: A consecutive series with long-term follow-up evaluation. J Neurosurg 1991;
74/2:163170.
39 Saunders RL: Anterior reconstructive procedures in cervical spondylotic myelopathy. Clin
Neurosurg 1991;37:682721.
40 Fessler RG, Steck JC, Giovanini MA: Anterior cervical corpectomy for cervical spondylotic
myelopathy. Neurosurgery 1998;43/2:257265.
41 Edwards CC 2nd, Heller JG, Murakami H: Corpectomy versus laminoplasty for multilevel cervi
cal myelopathy: An independent matched cohort analysis. Spine 2002;27/11:11681175.
Casey/Crockard 152
dramroo
42 Hosono N, Yonenobu K, Ono K: Neck and shoulder pain after laminoplasty. A noticeable compli
cation. Spine 1996;21:19691973.
43 Adams CB, Logue V: Studies in cervical spondylotic myelopathy. II. The movement and contour
of the spine in relation to the neural complications of cervical spondylosis. Brain 1971;94:
568586.
44 Adams CB, Logue V: Studies in cervical spondylotic myelopathy. III. Some functional effects of
operations for cervical spondylotic myelopathy. Brain 1971;94:587594.
45 Herkowitz HN: The surgical management of cervical spondylotic radiculopathy and myelopathy.
Clin Orthop 1989/239:94108.
46 Herkowitz HN: Cervical laminoplasty: Its role in the treatment of cervical radiculopathy. J Spinal
Disord 1988;1/3:179188.
47 Baba H, Maezawa Y, Furusawa N, Imura S, Tomita K: Flexibility and alignment of the cervical
spine after laminoplasty for spondylotic myelopathy. A radiographic study. Int Orthop 1995;19/2:
116121.
48 Heller JG, Edwards CC 2nd, Murakami H, Rodts GE: Laminoplasty versus laminectomy and
fusion for multilevel cervical myelopathy: An independent matched cohort analysis. Spine 2001;
26:13301336.
49 Herkowitz HN: A comparison of anterior cervical fusion, cervical laminectomy, and cervical
laminoplasty for the surgical management of multiple level spondylotic radiculopathy. Spine
1988;13:774780.
50 Baisden J, Voo LM, Cusick JF, Pintar FA, Yoganandan N: Evaluation of cervical laminectomy and
laminoplasty. A longitudinal study in the goat model. Spine 1999;24:12831289.
51 Uematsu Y, Tokuhashi Y, Matsuzaki H: Radiculopathy after laminoplasty of the cervical spine.
Spine 1998;23:20572062.
Laminoplasty 153
dramroo
Haid RW Jr, Subach BR, Rodts GE Jr (eds): Advances in Spinal Stabilization.
in Spinal Stabilization
b
Department of Neurosurgery, Emory University, Atlanta, Ga.,
c
Department of Neurosurgery, The Mayo Clinic, Scottsdale, Ariz., and
d
Indiana Spine Group, Indianapolis, Ind., USA
Since Hadra [8] first used silver wires to internally fixate the cervical
spine in 1891, cervical spinal fixation has undergone significant transforma
tion. Posterior instrumentation systems have evolved from wires to facet
screws, lateral mass plates, and ultimately to cervical pedicle screws. These
advances in cervical stabilization techniques have been accompanied by inno
vative spine image guidance systems to assist with appropriate placement.
Transpedicular fixation of the cervical spine poses a particular challenge
to surgeons due to the close proximity of the cervical pedicle to the spinal cord,
nerve roots and the vertebral arteries. Nevertheless, possible biomechanical
advantages afforded by cervical pedicle screws over lateral mass screws and
posterior cervical wires are the primary factor in the continuing study and
advancement in pedicle screw application for cervical spine fixation.
Anatomy
Due to the small margin of error allowed for ideal cervical pedicle screw
placement, even small miscalculations can result in a vascular or neural injury.
Therefore, intimate knowledge of the cervical pedicles is important.
dramroo
Table 1. Pedicle dimensions
C2 C3 C4 C5 C6 C7 T1
in 1991 were among the first to understand the three-dimensional anatomy of the
cervical pedicle and to propose that the cervical pedicle could tolerate pedicle
screw placement. In their cadaveric study of 12 cervical spines, Panjabi et al.
systematically demonstrated that both the width and height of the cervical pedicle
was the greatest at C2 (C2 width and height were on the average 7.7 and 9.4 mm,
respectively) (table 1). In addition, they demonstrated that the cross-sectional area
of the C2 pedicle was the greatest of all the cervical pedicles. From C3C7, the
pedicle angles to the transverse plane ranged from an average of 9.2 below to
13.4 above the transverse plane. In the sagittal plane, there was a decrement of
the pedicle angle from an average of 41.6 at C3 to 33.1 at C7.
Other cadaveric studies have also demonstrated the feasibility of placing
screws within the cervical pedicle. An et al. [6] in 1991 utilized a cadaveric
study to investigate the pedicle anatomy from C7T2. In terms of C7 pedicle
anatomy, they demonstrated that the medial angulation averaged 34 at C7,
while the mediolateral and superoinferior outer pedicle diameters were on aver
age 6.9 and 7.5 mm, respectively. The pedicle distances (from the entry point
to the posterior vertebral body line) measured 9.1 mm on average. An et al. rec
ommended that for pedicle screw placement, the entry point should be 1 mm
inferior to the midpoint of the facet with a 2530 medial angle.
Shin et al. [19] further defined the cervical pedicle anatomy by addressing
cross-sectional variability of the cervical pedicles. They demonstrated that the
medial pedicle walls are consistently thicker than the lateral pedicle walls and
that there was a substantial variability in the composition and shape of the cer
vical pedicle cross section.
Both Xu et al. [23] and Ugur et al. [22] expanded on prior anatomical stud
ies by evaluating the relationship between the cervical pedicles and the adjacent
neural structures. These studies showed that there was no gap between the pedi
cle and the superior portion of the nerve root and between the pedicle and the
thecal sac from C3 to C7. The average distances between the pedicle and the
inferior nerve root margins ranged from 1.4 to 1.6 mm. Consequently, both
studies concluded that the risk of neurological injuries may be higher in screw
penetration of the medial or superior cortex of the pedicle rather than in screw
penetration of the inferior cortex of the pedicle (fig. 1).
Technique Studies
Ludwig et al. [15] compared the accuracy of three different techniques for
placing pedicle screws in cadaveric specimens. With screws placed based on
morphometric data alone, 12.5% of the screws were placed entirely within
the pedicle; 21.9% had a noncritical breach, and 65% had a critical breach
(critical: encroachment of vertebral artery, nerve root or spinal cord by the
screw, noncritical: violation of the pedicle cortex without injury to surrounding
vital structure). In the second technique (laminoforaminotomy), 45% of the
screws were within the pedicle; 15.4% had a noncritical breach, and 39.6% had
a critical breach. In the third technique (computer-assisted surgical guidance
system), 76% of the screws were placed entirely within the pedicle; 13.4% had
a noncritical breach, and 10.6% had a critical breach.
Biomechanical Studies
Once the feasibility of screw placement within the cervical pedicle was
demonstrated, biomechanical studies were required to justify the use of cervical
pedicle screw fixation in light of the technically challenging nature of pedicle
screw placement. Kotani et al. [13] in 1994 compared the biomechanical stability
Chun/Mummaneni/Birch/Sasso 156
dramroo
of seven different cervical fixation methods, including transpedicular screw
fixation. They demonstrated that the three-column fixation of the cervical spine
using cervical pedicle screws offered increased stability over other posterior
cervical fixation systems. Even when both the anterior and middle columns were
compromised, the stability provided by cervical pedicle fixation was similar to
combined anterior plate and posterior triple wiring in one-level fixation.
Additionally, Jones et al. [10] in 1997 demonstrated in cadaveric speci
mens that cervical pedicle screws had a significantly higher pullout strength
than lateral mass screws. The load failure mean for cervical pedicle screws was
677 N in contrast to 355 N for lateral mass screws.
Kowalski et al. [14] in 2000 further evaluated the pullout strengths of
pedicle screws. They compared the standard method of pedicle screw place
ment (decortication of the lateral mass and passage of a hand drill prior to tapping)
to the Abumi insertion method (decortication of the entire lateral mass, which
provides a direct view of the pedicle introitus). There was no significant differ
ence in the mean pullout resistance between the Abumi (696 N) and standard
(636.5 N) insertion techniques (p 0.41).
These studies demonstrated that cervical pedicle screw constructs are
biomechanically stronger than lateral mass screw or wire fixation systems.
Clinical Studies
In 1989 Roy-Camille [25] described the technique and the indication for
the placement of a transpars screw at C2 for Hangmans fractures. For C2, he
recommended drilling approximately 15 in the medial direction and 35 in the
superior direction.
Abumi et al. [1] in 1994 was the first to report placement of pedicle screws
in the subaxial spine. Thirteen patients with fractures/dislocation of the middle
and lower cervical spine underwent transpedicular screw fixation. The angle of
the cervical pedicle screws of Abumi et al. ranged from 25 to 45 medial to the
midline in the transverse plane. All patients had solid fusion without loss of cor
rection at an average of 22 months follow-up. Despite three cortical breaches
of the 52 screws that were placed, no neurological or vascular complications
were observed. This study demonstrated that safe and successful placement of
cervical pedicle screws was possible.
Abumi and Kaneda [2] further utilized pedicle screw fixation for nontrau
matic lesions of the cervical spine. They analyzed the clinical results in 45
patients and demonstrated that the solid fusion was obtained in all patients
except 8 patients who did not receive bone graft. There was one case of
transient radiculopathy.
Surgical Technique
For posterior cervical pedicle screw (and lateral mass screw) fixation, we
prefer to use a polyaxial screw-rod system (VERTEX, Medtronic Sofamor
Danek, Memphis, Tenn., USA). This system is more versatile than standard lat
eral mass plating systems and allows for more varied screw entry points and
screw angles because the screw placement is not dependent on the predeter
mined plate entry holes.
Chun/Mummaneni/Birch/Sasso 158
dramroo
2 3
Fig. 2. A C2 pars screw (A) has a higher risk of vertebral artery injury than a C2 pedi
cle screw (B) because the vertebral artery runs occasionally through the inferior portion of
the pars of C2. SAP Superior articulating process; IAP inferior articulating process.
Fig. 3. The trajectory of a C2 pedicle screw (A) and the trajectory of a C2 pars screw
(B) are shown.
(this is more medial angulation than the pars screw as the entry point is more
lateral). We also angle approximately 25 in the superior direction. We use
fluoroscopy or image guidance to help with screw trajectory.
Since the vertebral artery occasionally runs within the inferior pars of C2,
the entry point of the C2 pedicle screw is safer than the entry point of the C2
pars screw because the C2 pedicle screw entry point is more superior than the
entry point of the C2 pars screw.
Violation of the medial pedicle wall is unlikely with a C2 pedicle screw
because the bone here is cortical and quite strong. We prefer to use the tap from
the VERTEX set to enter and create a screw pathway because the tap is less
likely to create a cortical wall breach than is the drill.
Chun/Mummaneni/Birch/Sasso 160
dramroo
Fig. 6. Lateral cervical spine x-ray of subaxial pedicle screws.
Chun/Mummaneni/Birch/Sasso 162
dramroo
landmarks and medial pedicle wall palpation with a Penfield 4 are adequate for
accurate screw placement.
Conclusion
References
1 Abumi K, Itoh H, Taneichi H, Kaneda K: Transpedicular screw fixation for traumatic lesions of the
middle and lower cervical spine: Description of the techniques and preliminary report. J Spinal Disord
1994;7:1928.
2 Abumi K, Kaneda K: Pedicle screw fixation for nontraumatic lesions of the cervical spine. Spine
1997;22:18531863.
3 Abumi K, Kaneda K, Shono Y, Fujiya M: One-stage posterior decompression and reconstruction
of the cervical spine by using pedicle screw fixation systems. J Neurosurg 1999;90:1926.
Chun/Mummaneni/Birch/Sasso 164
dramroo
Haid RW Jr, Subach BR, Rodts GE Jr (eds): Advances in Spinal Stabilization.
Prog Neurol Surg. Basel, Karger, 2003, vol 16, pp 165175
Posterior cervical fixation utilizing lateral mass plates has been shown to
be a safe and efficacious method to achieve cervical fusion [13]. Lateral mass
plating is biomechanically superior to laminar wiring or clamping in limiting
cervical motion [47]. In addition, unlike posterior laminar wiring or clamp
ing, lateral mass plating does not require the presence of the posterior
elements.
However, lateral mass plates have numerous drawbacks. They are difficult
to contour, and the screw positions are dictated by the fixed plate entry holes.
In addition, the screw trajectories are divergent from the plate entry holes, and
the connection of the screw to the plate is not rigid. There is no space to pack
autograft bone under the screw-plate connection. Screws placed medially or lat
erally cannot be captured by the plate. Successive screws cannot be compressed
or distracted because of the fixed plate hole distances. Moreover, if the plate
needs to be revised, the screws must be removed. Finally, most of the systems
currently available do not easily allow for extension of fusion up to the occiput
or down to the thoracic spine [8].
The ideal posterior cervical instrumentation system will address these
shortfalls from the lateral mass plate systems. Currently, there are three com
mercially available systems that address the problems of lateral mass plates.
These systems do allow for initial screw placement with subsequent rod con
touring. The three systems are Starlock/Cervifix (Synthes USA, Paoli, Pa.,
USA), SUMMIT (DePuy Acromed, Raynham, Mass., USA), and VERTEX
(Medtronic Sofamor Danek, Memphis, Tenn., USA).
dramroo
Instrumentation
The three systems that allow for initial screw placement with subsequent
rod attachment differ from each other in several ways.
Mummaneni/Traynelis/Sasso 166
dramroo
that fit inside the screw head. The VERTEX systems polyaxial screw heads are
very low profile as a result of this attachment scheme [10].
The VERTEX system is easily adaptable for occipital and thoracic exten
sions. It consists of 6- to 10-mm titanium occipital screws (which are not
polyaxial) and 14- to 18-mm titanium polyaxial cervicothoracic screws. In
addition, noncannulated 4050 mm transarticular titanium polyaxial screws are
available for C1/C2 fusion. The systems titanium rods are malleable in three
dimensions, and there is an available rod with an occipital plate on one end to
allow for occipitocervical fusions.
With the VERTEX system, occipitocervical fusion can be performed, but
the nonpolyaxial occipital screws must be placed through the apertures in the
occipital plates. The polyaxial cervicothoracic screws, however, are placed
independently of the rod system. These polyaxial 14- to 18-mm screws are ideal
for placement in the C1 lateral mass, C2 pars, C37 lateral masses, and upper
thoracic pedicles [10, 11]. The contoured rods are then linked either directly to
the polyaxial screw heads with a locking cap screw or are linked via an offset
connector.
Mummaneni/Traynelis/Sasso 168
dramroo
a 2025 010 b
Fig. 1. Illustration of the lateral mass screw trajectory in the axial plane. a Appropriate
angle. b The screw trajectory puts the nerve root at risk.
the entry point. Screw depth is guided by lateral fluoroscopy and can be esti
mated by preoperative Stealth CT planning.
For screw placement into the C2 pars, we pay close attention to the preop
erative CT to assess the course of the vertebral artery. In addition, we palpate
the medial pars with a blunt probe to help guide our screw trajectory. We utilize
a screw entry point 3 mm superior and lateral (3 mm up and out) to the medial
aspect of the C2/3 facet joint. The screw trajectory is 1015 medial and 35
cephalad. We typically use 4-mm width and 16-mm length screws for the C2
pars [10, 11].
For C1/2 transarticular screw placement, the entry point and trajectory are
the same as for C2 pars screws; the screw length, however, is longer (up to 50 mm
Mummaneni/Traynelis/Sasso 170
dramroo
Fig. 3. Optimal screw placement
positions for occipital fixation.
Fig. 5. Photograph of the VERTEX system. Note the polyaxial screw heads, the offset
connector, and the laminar hook.
for lateral mass fixation from C37 as well as pedicle fixation and laminar
hook placement in the lower cervical and upper thoracic spine without the
limitations inherent in placing screws through holes in lateral mass plates
(fig. 58). Finally, the rods are easily contoured and attached directly and
rigidly to the polyaxial screw heads.
Mummaneni/Traynelis/Sasso 172
dramroo
Fig. 6. Photograph of occipitocervicothoracic fixation in a saw bone model utilizing
the VERTEX system.
7 8
The VERTEX system has advantages over the SUMMIT system. VERTEX
is lower profile than the SUMMIT system and more easily accommodates com
plex cervical curvatures and spondylosis as a result. In addition, VERTEX has
top-loading offset connectors to easily accommodate cervicothoracic pedicle
screws.
Further studies will be required to establish long-term results and fusion
rates with the cervical screw-rod systems.
We are grateful to Drew Imhulse for assistance with the radiographic images in the figures.
Disclosure Statement
The following authors are consultants for Medtronic Sofamor Danek: Vincent C.
Traynelis, MD and Rick C. Sasso, MD.
References
1 Anderson PA, Henley MB, Grady MS, Montesano PX, Winn HR: Posterior cervical arthrodesis
with AO reconstruction plates and bone graft. Spine 1991;16(suppl 3):S72S79.
2 Fehlings MG, Cooper PR, Errico TJ: Posterior plates in the management of cervical instability:
Long-term results in 44 patients. J Neurosurg 1994;81:341349.
3 Graham AW, Swank ML, Kinard RE, Lowery GL, Dials BE: Posterior cervical arthrodesis and
stabilization with a lateral mass plate: Clinical and computed tomographic evaluation of lateral
mass screw placement and associated complications. Spine 1996;21:323329.
4 Gill K, Paschal S, Corin J, Ashman R, Bucholz RW: Posterior plating of the cervical spine: A bio
mechanical comparison of different posterior fusion techniques. Spine 1988;13:813816.
5 Heller JG, Silcox DH 3rd, Sutterlin CE 3rd: Complications of posterior cervical plating. Spine
1995;20:24422448.
6 Sutterlin CE, McAfee PC, Warden KE, Rey RM, Farey ID: A biomechanical evaluation of cervi
cal spinal stabilization methods in a bovine model: Static and cyclical loading. Spine 1988;13:
795802.
7 Ulrich C, Woersdoerfer O, Kalff R, Claes L, Wilke HJ: Biomechanics of fixation systems to the
cervical spine. Spine 1991;16(suppl 3):S4S9.
8 Smith MD, Anderson P, Grady MS: Occipitocervical arthrodesis using contoured plate fixation:
An early report on a versatile fixation technique. Spine 1993;18:19841990.
9 Horgan MA, Kellogg JX, Chesnut RM: Posterior cervical arthrodesis and stabilization: An early
report using a novel lateral mass screw and rod technique. Neurosurgery 1999;44:12671272.
10 Mummaneni PV, Haid RW, Traynelis VC, Sasso RC, Subach BR, Fiore AJ, Rodts GE: Posterior
cervical fixation using a new polyaxial screw and rod system: Technique and surgical results.
Neurosurg Focus 2002;12/1:15.
11 Fiore AJ, Haid RW, Rodts GE, Subach BR, Mummaneni PV, Riedel CJ, Birch BD: C1 lateral mass
screws for posterior spinal reconstruction: Technical note and case series. Neurosurg Focus
2002;12/1:16.
12 McCafferty RR, Haid RW, Martin G, Rodts GE: Techniques for lateral mass plating of the post
erior cervical spine in patients with cervical spinal stenosis. Tech Neurosurg 1999;5/2:101105.
13 Harms J, Melcher RP: Posterior C1C2 fusion with polyaxial screw and rod fixation. Spine
2001;26:24672471.
14 Haid RW Jr: C1C2 transarticular screw fixation: Technical aspects. Neurosurgery 2001;49:
7174.
15 Haid RW Jr, Subach BR, McLaughlin MR, Rodts GE Jr, Wahlig JB Jr: C1C2 transarticular screw
fixation for atlantoaxial instability: A 6-year experience. Neurosurgery 2001;49:6568.
16 Youkilis AS, Quint DJ, McGillicuddy JE, Papadopoulos SM: Stereotactic navigation for place
ment of pedicle screws in the thoracic spine. Neurosurgery 2001;48:771778.
17 Oda I, Abumi K, Sell LC, Haggerty CJ, Cunningham BW, McAfee PC: Biomechanical evaluation
of five different occipito-atlanto-axial fixation techniques. Spine 1999;24:23772382.
Mummaneni/Traynelis/Sasso 174
dramroo
18 Schultz KD Jr, McLaughlin MR, Haid RW Jr, Comey CH, Rodts GE Jr, Alexander J: Single-stage
anterior-posterior decompression and stabilization for complex cervical spine disorders. J Neurosurg
2000;93(suppl 2):214221.
19 Swank MA, Sutterlin CE 3rd, Bossons CR, Dials BE: Rigid internal fixation with lateral mass
plates in multilevel anterior and posterior reconstruction of the cervical spine. Spine 1997;22:
274282.
20 Wellman BJ, Follett KA, Traynelis VC: Complications of posterior articular mass plate fixation of
the subaxial cervical spine in 43 consecutive patients. Spine 1998;23:193200.
Praveen V. Mummaneni, MD
Tel. 1 404 686 8101, Fax 1 404 686 4805, E-Mail [email protected]
The fusion of spinal segments is one of the major goals in surgical treat
ment of degenerative disc disease (DDD). To obtain the best biomechanical
support and fusion rates, interbody fusion is the preferred method. The main
advantages of implants made of carbon fiber reinforced plastic (CFRP) are the
radiolucency and the fact that there is no distortion on CT and MRI. The
surgeon can chronologically follow the biological reaction in the fusion section
and can clearly detect bony fusion. Regions which are hidden using metal
implants could now be analyzed on standard radiographs. In implants made of
CFRP matrix materials such as thermoset epoxy resin systems (EPN/DDS) or
thermoplastic systems PEAK (PEKEKK, PEEK, ULTRAPEK) are
used. The first ones have been clinically used since 1988 following detailed
in vitro and in vivo tests starting 1975 according to ISO 10993-1 [1]. In the
spine these implant materials have been used since 1993 [2].
These CFRP implants are manufactured using a special fiber winding process
of carbon fiber roving which is impregnated with resin and laid on a rotating rod.
Due to that and to the design-adapted machining processes the properties of the
material could be chosen for each kind of implant design. Hardening, tempering,
and machining lead to the final implant geometry and must be controlled.
Interbody fusion with cage support is an ideal situation for the application of
resorbable biomaterials [3, 4]. To monitor the production of the new bone masses
and to determine the degree of bone fusion, cages made from carbon composite
materials are superior to metallic cages due to their radiolucent characteristics.
In the literature some mechanical and in vitro tests performed on CFRP
implants could be found: Brantigan et al. [5], Ciapetta et al. [6] (vertebra
replacement), Jost et al. [7], Kandziora et al. [8] (80 cervical spines of sheep
with different cage designs), Shono et al. [9] (18 calf spines in compression and
rotation), and Steinhauser et al. [10] (static and dynamic compression and shear
dramroo
Fiber Matrix
Fig. 1. Cross section and SEM (artificial fracture) of CFRP implants: carbon fiber
with a diameter of 5 m surrounded by matrix material.
testing) all showed very good results. The first animal tests of CFRP implants
as interbody lumbar fusion devices were done by Brantigan et al. [5]; they
reported 100% fusion after 6, 12 and 24 months in 27 Spanish goats. A sum
mary of clinical experience with CFRP cages is shown in table 1. In all cases
high fusion rates were detected with no device-related complications. One case
report showed infection and a broken CFRP cage (see table 1) [17].
Mechanical Tests
To test the axial compression and shear behavior the spinal implants were loaded
between two parallel stainless steel plates according to ASTM F2077-00. An axial force rate
of 500 N/min was used for quasistatic testing. The loading was stopped when a permanent
failure of the specimen occurred or a displacement of 3.0 mm was reached.
For dynamic testing the specimens were tested under cyclic fatigue using a sinusoidal
loading waveform at a constant frequency of 5 Hz (lumbar) and 12 Hz (cervical), with an
R ratio (Pmin/Pmax) of 0.1. The maximum load cycle was 5,000,000 cycles and a displace
ment limit error of 3 mm was established.
To determine the pull-out strength, the implants were placed in between two blocks
made of Rohacell RC 300WL with mechanical properties comparable to cancellous bone. An
axial preload of 100 N was applied. The instrument intended for clinical use was attached
PLIF Posterior lumbar interbody fusion; ALIF anterior lumbar interbody fusion.
Clinical Experience
The fusion devices to be assessed at the postoperative evaluation were the CORNER
STONE-SR C (lordotically shaped anterior cervical interbody fusion device, Medtronic
Sofamor Danek) and UNION or UNION-L (lordotically shaped anterior or lateral lumbar
interbody fusion device, Medtronic Sofamor Danek) spinal fusion cages.
The implant system CORNERSTONE-SR C consists of a basic body (12 13 mm),
various heights of 48 mm (1016 mm) and two lines of fins (see fig. 2). The anterior
retroperitoneal implant system UNION or UNION-L consists of a basic body (24 26 or
26 31 mm, respectively) with two chambers, various heights of 1016 mm and three lines
of fins (see fig. 2). For both types of implants x-ray contrasts are layers of BaSO4 embedded
into the CFRP material. Prior insertion of the implant the fins must be prepared in the bone
with a special instrument.
Bertagnoli 178
dramroo
a b
Fig. 3. Minimum follow-up of the CFRP cervical and lumbar fusion implants:
CORNERSTONE-SR C (n 126) and UNION (n 89).
Bertagnoli 180
dramroo
The neurological status was assessed postoperatively using a comprehensive neurolog
ical status scale ranging from 0 (worst) to 100 (best). Pre- and postoperatively each patient
rated the frequency of their back/leg pain on a scale of 110. Patient satisfaction questions
and success are defined as either a completely recovered, much improvement, or slightly
improved response.
For the prospective study the arm/neck score was used to evaluate and compare the pain
intensity and frequency in the cervical groups (with 1 equal to no pain or never and
10 equal to extremely painful or always). The results of the lumbar group were evaluated
and compared using the Oswestry score. In this scale patients can receive a maximum value
of 5 points and a minimum value of 0 points on each of the 10 criteria being used.
Clinical examination and comparative measurements were performed on AP and lateral
radiographs as well as on flexion/extension films in order to estimate the position of the
cages, the degree of restoration of the disc height of the intervertebral discs and the density
of the fusion area. MRIs were taken at defined times to verify possible edema that had been
reported when using graft material. CTs and regular tomograms were also used to evaluate
new bone formation inside the cages.
The standard mechanical tests showed the superior strength of the CFRP
fusion devices. The cervical fusion device (CORNERSTONE-SR C) has a high
compression and shear load (see fig. 7) which is more than 20 times above the
normal load in the cervical spine [18]. Pull-out and torsion tests show significant
differences between designs with and without the fins (see fig. 8) but even for the
nonfin version the values reached are above the daily loads [18]. Figure 9 shows
the compression and shear behavior of the CFRP lumbar fusion device UNION.
No significant differences could be detected between different sizes (small
and medium) and different heights (10 up to 20 mm) of the implants. The com
pression load is more than 4 times higher than the load during daily activities
[18]. The fatigue behavior due to compression and shear load is shown in
figure 10. Run-out load is much higher than could be detected during daily
activities. In the clinical studies no intraoperative or device-related complications
were observed in either group. In all cervical and lumbar cases of the retro
spective study, 100% fusion was determined.
In the cervical group the mean preoperative back/leg pain frequency score
was 7.3 and the mean postoperative back/leg pain frequency score was 5.2
(28.8% improvement) (one clinical case, see fig. 4af). In the lumbar group the
mean preoperative back/leg pain frequency score was 7.9 and the mean post
operative back/leg pain frequency score was 6.2 (21.5% improvement) (two
clinical cases, see fig. 5ac, 6ad).
In the cervical group patients were satisfied with the results of surgery in
81.6%, surgery helped as much as patient thought it would in 79.0%, and
a b c
patients would have the same surgery again in 80.7% of the cases. In the lum
bar group patients were satisfied with results of surgery in 71.4%, surgery
helped as much as patient thought it would in 57.2%, and patient would have
the same surgery again in 67.5% of the cases. The independent physicians
assessment showed in 95.3% of the cervical and 97.7% of the lumbar cases
excellent or good results (see table 3). 6% of the cervical and 13% of the lum
bar patients in the retrospective study showed general and local complications.
Bertagnoli 182
dramroo
a b c d
Fig. 6. ad Radiography showing the CFRP fusion implant UNION-L (L4L5, visible
due to a BaSO4 layer in the implants): 42-year-old female, failed back disc surgery in 1999,
vertical segmental instability L4L5, severe low back pain, minor radicular pain, unsuccess
ful conservative treatment. Posterior neurolysis L5 and stabilization L4L5, ALPA approach.
Good realignment of lumbar lordosis and secure fusion at the 12-month checkup.
4
Load (kN)
0
CORNERSTONE-SR C 5mm CORNERSTONE-SR C 4mm
Fig. 7. Compression and shear strength of the CFRP cervical interbody fusion cage
CORNERSTONE-SR C tested according to ASTM F2077-00.
In the cervical group of the prospective study 97% fusion could be detected
radiographically; in 1 patient (3%) due to only one early check-up at 6 weeks
after surgery fusion could not be evaluated. The mean arm/neck pain score
improved significantly from 7.6 preoperatively to 4.2 after 12 months (45%
improvement), the arm/neck pain frequency score from 8.8 to 5.4 after 12 months
(39% improvement). 87.5% of the patients felt there was an improvement
80 4
p0.05
Torque (Nm)
Load (N)
60 3
40 2
20 1
0 0
Pull-out test Torsion
Fig. 8. Pull-out force and torsion behavior of CFRP cervical interbody fusion devices:
comparison of implants with rails (CORNERSTONE-SR C) and without rails (CORNER
STONE-SR C serrated).
60
40
Load (kN)
20
0
UNION small 14mm UNION medium 20mm UNION large 15mm
Fig. 9. Compression and shear strength of the CFRP anterior lumbar interbody fusion
cage UNION tested according to ASTM F2077-00.
and were satisfied after 12 months, the results of surgery met the expectations of
75%, and 87.5% would have the same surgery again.
In the lumbar group 100% fusion could be detected radiographically; no
pseudarthrosis was determined. The mean Oswestry score was 52.3 before
surgery and improved after 6 months to 16.2 (69% improvement). 90.0% of the
Bertagnoli 184
dramroo
30
UNION medium 11mm
UNION large 15mm
25
Maximum load (kN)
20
15
10
Run-out
0
10,000 100,000 1,000,000 10,000,000
Cycles
Fig. 10. S/N curve of compression and shear strength of the CFRP anterior lumbar
interbody fusion cage UNION tested according to ASTM F2077-00.
patients felt there was an improvement and were satisfied after 6 months, the
results of surgery met the expectations of 80%, and 60.0% would have the same
surgery again. Only 1 patient was not satisfied with the result.
Conclusion
References
Bertagnoli 186
dramroo
15 Commarmond J: One-segment interbody lumbar arthrodesis using impacted cages: Posterior
unilateral approach versus posterior bilateral approach. Rev Chir Orthop Reparatrice Appar Mot
2001;87:129134.
16 Brooke NSR, Rorke AW, King AT, Gullan RW: Preliminary experience of carbon fibre cage
prostheses for treatment of cervical spine disorders. Br J Neurosurg 1997;11:221227.
17 Tullberg T: Failure of a carbon fiber implant. A case report. Spine 1998;23:18041806.
18 White AA, Panjabi MM: Clinical Biomechanics of the Spine, ed 2. Philadelphia, Lippincott, 1990.
Preoperative Assessment
One of the first assessments that needs to be made by the surgeon contem
plating the use of thoracic pedicle screws for the treatment of various surgical
spinal disorders is whether the thoracic pedicle is large enough to probe down
with a pedicle probe and subsequently accept a screw of appropriate and avail
able diameter and length. There is a wide spectrum of individual pedicle dimen
sions, with the limiting dimension always being the medial to lateral diameter at
the isthmus in millimeters [1215]. This can range from only 23 mm in the mid
thoracic region up to 10 mm at the lower thoracic levels. Interestingly, the
smallest pedicle dimensions are usually found at the T5T7 levels. Pedicle
dramroo
isthmus dimensions increase both above and below these mid thoracic levels,
being consistently larger in the lower thoracic region (T10T12), and somewhat
smaller in the proximal thoracic region (T1T3). Because of the varied anatomy
and pedicle sizes, it is extremely important to have a variety of choices for ped
icle screw diameters available ranging from a 4.0-mm all the way through a
7.5-mm diameter in 0.5-mm increments. The goal should be to maximize fit into
the pedicle cortex with the largest screw that will safely fit. The lengths of the
screws will vary but range from 4050 mm in length in the lower thoracic
regions to 2535 mm in length in the proximal thoracic levels. The lengths will
depend on patient size, and orientation of the screw, and will be shorter if the
trajectory is somewhat lateral. It is also helpful to have both fixed head and
multiaxial screws available. I tend to use fixed head screws in the thoracic spine,
for they are lower profile and allow more room for bone grafting. However,
multiaxial screws can easily be used as well.
In most instances, standard AP and lateral radiographs will adequately
demonstrate the pedicle dimensions required to confirm the size of the thoracic
pedicles and the ability of the surgeon to navigate down them into the body.
One must remember that in a true frontal plane radiograph of the thoracic spine,
the pedicles that are perfectly perpendicular to the x-ray beam will have the
most accurate representation of their overall dimensions. With increasing
thoracic kyphosis, the ability to adequately assess the pedicles above and below
the apex will be diminished and occasionally additional views may be helpful
in assessing pedicle dimensions in these specific cases. As an alternative, a
preoperative CT scan can be obtained with a single slice through each mid
pedicle level to check on overall isthmus dimensions. In my experience, these
CT dimensions somewhat underestimate the diameter of the screw that can be
placed since there does appear that cortical expansion occurs with aggressive
tapping and final screw placement. This will be discussed further in the tech
niques section of this report. I would caution against using a preoperative MRI
to assess pedicle dimensions as it appears to underestimate the true cortical size
due to artifacts that can occur during the acquisition process.
It is much more difficult to assess rotated pedicles, such as those located at
the concave apex of scoliosis deformities. For scoliosis cases, we rely on the
assessment of pedicle dimensions noted at proximal and distal levels away from
the apex where the vertebrae become more neutral in orientation. Routinely, if
the pedicle dimensions are adequate at these more neutral levels, the pedicles will
be accessible at the concave apical levels. Also, analyzing the convex-sided ped
icle dimensions can provide information on the corresponding concave pedicles.
The major difference is that the concave pedicles will tend to be more cortical
than the more cancellous centered convex pedicles, although they appear to be
relatively the same size at least in adolescent idiopathic scoliosis patients [16].
Lenke 190
dramroo
Table 1. 8 steps of the free-hand technique of thoracic pedicle screw placement
Step Description
Exposure (see fig. 1) Thorough and meticulous exposure to the tips of all transverse processes to
be included in the instrumentation/fusion.
Starting point and cortical Visualize the starting point based upon as much anatomical information as
burr (see fig. 2) possible. For noncontiguous levels, this may be limited to a review of the
pre- and intraoperative radiographs and orientation of the posterior elements.
However, with successive levels, much information is provided by making
fine adjustments to the trajectory of the previous levels screw or contralateral
screw. Use a 5.0-mm acorn-tipped burr (or smaller burr in smaller patients) to
thin the posterior cortex and enter the pedicle. The pedicle blush should be
visualized suggesting entrance into the cancellous bone of the pedicle. In
cases with smaller pedicles, especially in the apical concavity of scoliosis
patients, there will be very limited intrapedicular cancellous bone and
therefore a pedicle blush may not be observed.
Pedicle gearshift-lateral Use a 2-mm blunt-tipped, slightly curved pedicle finder (thoracic gearshift)
(see fig. 3) facing laterally to enter the pedicle. Often the endosteal diameter of the
pedicle is quite small, so allowing the finder to fall into the pedicle. The
thoracic gearshift should be perpendicular to the plane of the superior facet
and/or lamina. Aiming slightly laterally initially will help to avoid medial
wall perforations. Rotate the pedicle finder to a medially faced orientation
after a depth of approximately 1520 mm is attained (the average length of a
typical pedicle). Carefully place the tip to the base of the prior hole before
advancing the pedicle finder. Advance the finder to approximately the length
of the desired screw and then rotate the finder 180 to make room for the
screw. Make sure you feel bone the entire length of the pedicle. Any sudden
advancement of the gearshift suggests penetration into soft tissue and thus a
pedicle wall violation or vertebral body violation. These should be
investigated immediately in order to possibly salvage the pedicle and avoid
complications.
Pedicle palpation Use a flexible ball-tipped sounding device to palpate all 5 walls of the pedicle
(see fig. 4) (cephalad, caudad, medial, lateral, and floor). Pay special attention to the
junction of the middle and upper portions of the tract as this is the region of
the pedicle where the spinal canal is located. If any wall besides the medial
wall has been breached, the pedicle may be salvageable. In this circumstance,
place bone wax in the pedicle hole to limit bleeding and reangle the pedicle
finder with a more appropriate trajectory.
Pedicle tapping Tap the pedicle with a tap that is 0.5 mm smaller than the proposed screw.
(see fig. 5) If there is difficulty passing the tap, use the next smaller tap and then retap
the pedicle. If there is no anterior wall violation, one can use a K wire to
assist with guiding the path of the cannulated taps. If there is any question of
whether the anterior wall is intact, do not use a K wire as cardiac tamponade
due to K-wire-induced trauma to a coronary artery has been reported.
Step Description
Repeat pedicle palpation Use the palpating device a second time to assess the bony
(see fig. 6) pedicle walls and remeasure the tract length with a hemostat. Compare this
measurement directly adjacent to the screw to be placed to ensure appropriate
screw length.
Screw placement Place the screw slowly to confirm it is threaded properly and
(see fig. 7) allow for viscoelastic expansion of the pedicle. Make sure the angle of screw
insertion matches the tract previously palpated and tapped.
Confirmation of After all the screws have been placed, intraoperative
intraosseous screw radiographs are repeated prior to placing the rods in order to
placement (see fig. 8) confirm accurate placement of the screws. Some surgeons prefer to use
fluoroscopy in order to obtain a true AP of each level. The coronal plane
should show harmonious screw positions from proximal to distal. The sagittal
plane should demonstrate parallel orientation to the superior end-plate so that
no screw tip is anterior to the anterior vertebral body line. Perform EMG
assessment of the screws based upon rectus abdominis data. Frequently we use
active EMGs via the same approach through the pedicle finder or cannulated
tap to assess real-time monitoring of the thoracic nerve root. The screws with
the lowest impedance are removed and rechecked with a ball-tipped sounder
prior to replacement of the screw if intraosseous borders are confirmed.
Lenke 192
dramroo
T1 Thoracic Pedicle Screw Starting Points
T2 Cephalad-Caudad Medial-Lateral
Level
Starting Point Starting Point
T3
T1 Midpoint TP Junction: TP-Lamina
T4
T2 Midpoint TP Junction: TP-Lamina
T5
T3 Midpoint TP Junction: TP-Lamina
T6 Junction: Proximal
T4 Junction: TP-Lamina
third-Midpoint TP
Fig. 3. Use a 2-mm blunt-tipped, slightly curved pedicle finder (thoracic gearshift)
facing laterally to enter the pedicle.
Fig. 4. Sounding device to palpate all 5 walls of the pedicle (cephalad, caudad, medial,
lateral, and floor).
Fig. 5. Tap the pedicle with a tap that is 0.5 mm smaller than the proposed screw.
Lenke 194
dramroo
6
Fig. 6. Use the palpating device a second time to assess the bony pedicle walls.
Lenke 196
dramroo
Next, the pedicle tract is tapped with a tap undersized from the final
pedicle screw by 0.5 mm. I use a variety of color-coded cannulated taps that
range in diameter from 4.0 up to 6.5 mm with the threaded portion 35 mm in
length (Medtronic Sofamor-Danek). If necessary, a short K wire can be placed
into the pedicle tract as long as there is a floor for the K wire not to advance
through while tapping is undertaken. The K wire can be especially helpful if
more than one attempt is made to probe down the pedicle and a false passage has
been created. A K wire leading down the correct pathway can guide the tap into
the appropriate position. We have also found clinically, and confirmed biome
chanically, that undertapping by 0.5 mm will improve the screw ultimate pullout
strength. It is not necessary to tap the entire length of the pedicle screw tract,
only the portion deep into the isthmus of the pedicle usually meaning approxi
mately 2025 mm.
Following tapping, the pedicle is palpated again with a fine ball-tipped
sounding probe. Once again the floor and four walls (medial, lateral, superior
and inferior) should be confirmed intact to be completely intraosseous. There
is often a very nice cortical bony ridge that is palpated following the tapping
that absolutely confirms an intraosseous screw tract. It is important at this time
to confirm the appropriate length of the screw by measuring the length of the
sounding device while it is held deep against the floor of the vertebral body. We
will place a screw of a slightly smaller length so as not to penetrate anterior or
lateral to the vertebral body with an inadvertently long screw. The screw is then
placed in the same orientation as the pedicle tract was probed and tapped.
If the initial pedicle probe tract is found to be either medial or lateral, it
often can be redirected with the probe down the appropriate pedicle shaft. Even
with a medial wall defect, a new medial wall can be created with a pedicle
probe placed correctly down the pathway of the pedicle. However, this is not
always the case and in very tiny pedicles, often only one pass will be allowed
to successfully navigate the pedicle. Almost always if the initial pedicle probe
is lateral, the true pedicle pathway can be salvaged with a more medially
directed probe. Similar to the lumbar spine, if one is having difficulty finding
the start of the pedicle, it is best to err slightly more lateral. If one does exit
lateral initially, virtually no structures are at risk from minor lateral wall
penetrations, and the correct pedicle tract can almost always be salvaged in
these circumstances.
Lenke 198
dramroo
Results and Correlations of Thoracic Pedicle Screws
Placed by the Free-Hand Technique
9a 9b
9e 9f
Lenke 200
dramroo
9g 9h
References
1 Gaines RW: The use of pedicle-screw internal fixation for the operative treatment of spinal disor
ders. J Bone Joint Surg Am 2000;82:14581476.
2 Liljenqvist UR, Halm HF, Link TM: Pedicle screw instrumentation of the thoracic spine in idio
pathic scoliosis. Spine 1997;22:22392245.
3 Suk SI, Kim WJ, Lee SM, Kim JH, Chung ER: Thoracic pedicle screw fixation in spinal deform
ities: Are they really safe? Spine 2001;26:20492057.
4 Suk SI, Lee CK, Kim WJ, Chung YJ, Park YB: Segmental pedicle screw fixation in the treatment
of thoracic idiopathic scoliosis. Spine 1995;20:13991405.
5 Hamill CL, Lenke LG, Bridwell KH, Chapman MP: The use of pedicle screw fixation to improve
correction in the lumbar spine of patients with idiopathic scoliosis. Is it warranted? Spine 1996;
21:12411249.
6 Hirano T, Hasegawa K, Takahashi HE, Uchiyama S, Hara T, Washio T, Surgiura T, Yokaichiya M,
Ikeda M: Structural characteristics of the pedicle and its role in screw stability. Spine 1997;22:
25042510.
7 Krag MH, Weaver DL, Beynnon BD, Haugh LD: Morphometry of the thoracic and lumbar spine
related to transpedicular screw placement for surgical spinal fixation. Spine 1998;13/1:2732.
8 Liljenqvist UR, Link TM, Halm HF: Morphometric analysis of thoracic and lumbar vertebrae in
idiopathic scoliosis. Spine 2000;25:12471253.
9 Lonstein JE, Denis F, Perra JH, Pinto MR, Smith MD, Winter RB: Complications associated with
pedicle screws. J Bone Joint Surg Am 1999;81:15191528.
10 Vaccaro AR, Rizzolo SJ, Balderston RA, Allardyce TJ, Garfin SR, Dolinskas C, An HS:
Placement of pedicle screws in the thoracic spine. II. An anatomical and radiographic assessment.
J Bone Joint Surg Am 1995;77:12001206.
11 Kim Y, Lenke LG, Bridwell KH, Riew KD, Rhee JM, Hanson DS: Free hand pedicle screw place
ment in the thoracic spine (poster). Scoliosis Research Society 36th Annual Meeting, Cleveland,
2001.
12 Cinotti G, Gumina S, Ripani M, Postacchini F: Pedicle instrumentation in the thoracic spine.
A morphometric and cadaveric study for placement of screws. Spine 1999;24/2:114119.
13 Ebraheim NA, Xu R, Ahmad M, Yeasting RA: Projection of the thoracic pedicle and its morpho
metric analysis. Spine 1997;22/3:233238.
14 Kothe R, OHolleran JD, Liu W, Panjabi MM: Internal architecture of the thoracic pedicle.
An anatomic study. Spine 1996;21/3:264270.
15 Vaccaro AR, Rizzolo SJ, Allardyce TJ, Ramsey M, Salvo J, Balderston RA, Cotler JM: Placement
of pedicle screws in the thoracic spine. I. Morphometric analysis of the thoracic vertebrae. J Bone
Joint Surg Am 1995;77:11931199.
16 OBrien MF, Lenke LG, Mardjetko S, Lowe TG, Kong Y, Eck K, Smith D: Pedicle morphology in
thoracic adolescent idiopathic scoliosis: Is pedicle fixation an anatomically viable technique?
Spine 2000;25:22852293.
Lenke 202
dramroo
17 Ebraheim NA, Jabaly G, Xu R, Yeasting RA: Anatomic relations of the thoracic pedicle to the
adjacent neural structures. Spine 1997;22:15531557.
18 Brown CA, Lenke LG, Bridwell KH, Geideman WM, Hasan SA, Blanke K: Complications of
pediatric thoracolumbar and lumbar pedicle screws. Spine 1998;23:15661571.
19 Kim YJ, Lenke LG, Bridwell KH, Riew KD, OBrien M, Rhee JM, Hanson DS: CT scan accuracy
of free hand thoracic pedicle screw placement in pediatric spinal deformity (poster). Scoliosis
Research Society Annual Meeting, Cleveland, 2001.
20 Raynor BL, Lenke LG, Kim Y, Bridwell KH, Hanson DS, Padberg AM: Can triggered EMG
thresholds accurately predict thoracic pedicle screw placement? Spine, in press.
21 Kim Y, Lenke LG, Bridwell KH, Riew KD, Rhee JM, Hanson DS: Thoracic pedicle screw place
ment in deformity: Is it safe? (poster). Scoliosis Research Society 36th Annual Meeting,
Cleveland, 2001.
Lawrence G. Lenke, MD
One Barnes-Jewish Hospital Plaza, Suite 11300, St. Louis, MO 63110 (USA)
Tel. 1 314 747 2509, Fax 1 314 747 2599, E-Mail [email protected]
Indications
dramroo
tension band. As posterior endoscopic or other minimally invasive techniques
progress, percutaneous fixation may be combined with simultaneous laminec
tomy, discectomy, interbody or posterolateral fusion.
One indication for percutaneous posterior fixation is following a laparo
scopic or open (retroperitoneal or transperitoneal) anterior lumbar interbody
fusion (ALIF). Many surgeons do not rely on a stand-alone ALIF for the treat
ment of a mobile (unstable) lumbar spondylolisthesis. Whether threaded tita
nium cylinders, vertical carbon or titanium or ceramic cages, allograft femoral
ring wedges or threaded allograft bone dowels are used for the ALIF, the place
ment of posterior instrumentation in the setting of a mobile spondylolisthesis
provides greater biomechanical stability. Furthermore, studies have shown a
higher rate of pseudoarthrosis following stand-alone ALIF using allograft bone.
With posterior fixation, the rate of fusion following ALIF with bone-only is
improved.
Another consideration for the use of posterior percutaneous fixation is in
the case of a pseudoarthrosis following previous stand-alone ALIF. If a
nonunion is present yet the surgeon is satisfied with the structural integrity of
the previously implanted bone graft, posterior instrumentation ultimately can
help to achieve a successful arthrodesis. An example would be a case of previ
ous femoral ring ALIF with an intact graft, absence of subsidence or vertebral
body lysis, but no evidence of bone union on plain radiographs or CT with
reconstructions.
Percutaneous pedicle fixation is also a reasonable alternative to open
placement of instrumentation in the setting of a pseudoarthrosis following pre
vious posterolateral fusion. In this setting, decortication of the previous fusion
mass and placement of bone graft can be done through the same portals used
for percutaneous screw placement.
More recently, advances in less invasive techniques using tubular retractors
and blunt dissection through muscle have allowed for lumbar bone decompres
sion (laminectomy, laminotomy, medical facetectomy, discectomy), posterolat
eral fusion, and interbody fusion. Percutaneous pedicle screw fixation using the
same or different stab incisions may be a beneficial adjunct to these newer
approaches to decompression and arthrodesis.
Rodts 206
dramroo
Fig. 1. Virtual representation of probe extending through skin down to the level of
vertebral body (AP and lateral views) (photo courtesy of Kevin Foley, MD).
require bone removal. Another advantage of using the medial transverse process is that the
surgeon can palpate with a wire or other image-guided probe the superior and inferior edges
of the transverse process at the same time that visual feedback is given from the AP virtual
fluoroscopic view. One can then feel the slight groove where the transverse process meets the
superior facet process.
Using an image-guided drill guide, a K wire is drilled into the pedicle approximately
20 mm, allowing for entry into the posterior vertebral body. A cannulated pedicle probe can
then be passed or a cannulated drill bit can be used to drill the pedicle. A cannulated tap is
passed (usually) to the depth of the posterior vertebral body (fig. 4). Patients with sclerotic
or very firm bone may require tapping the full length of the intended screw. The pedicle is
now ready for screw placement.
An important part of the percutaneous instrumentation is the screw extender. A multi
axial screw (M8, Medtronic Sofamor Danek) is attached to a long arm that will cross the dis
tance between the posterior pedicle and the skin edge (fig. 5). A locking screw is preloaded
into the chamber of the screw extender. The outer end of the screw extender will attach to the
Sextant device.
For L5S1 fixation, a single longer stab incision can be made to accommodate place
ment of both the L5 and S1 screws and screw extenders. For L4L5 and higher levels, sepa
rate stab incisions will be necessary. Thus, once one screw has been placed, the sequence of
steps is repeated for placement of the second screw. When both screws have been placed, the
ends of the screw extenders are snapped together. The Sextant device with detachable trocar
is then attached to the end of the screw extender complex (fig. 6). The arm of the Sextant is
rotated down to the skin surface. This site is identified and a small stab incision is made. The
trocar is passed through the adipose layer, fascia, and bluntly through the muscle to the heads
of the multiaxial screws (fig. 7, 8). The arm is rotated back out. This step helps prepare for
Rodts 208
dramroo
6 7
Fig. 6. Sextant device with rod attached and screw extenders prior to percutaneous
delivery.
Fig. 7. Fluoroscopic view of rod inserted with tip of Sextant device visible inferiorly.
passage of the rod. The trocar is removed and a lordotic rod is attached to the arm of the
Sextant. The rod is delivered through the same fixed arc into the side openings of the multi
axial screws. One additional real-time fluoroscopic image is recommended to ensure proper
placement of the rod, though the fixed geometry of the screw extender Sextant system pro
vides for consistent accurate placement. The rod is detached from the delivery arm, and the
arm removed. The locking screws previously loaded into the screw extender chambers are
tightened to the appropriate torque tension with a screwdriver. Then, the complete apparatus
is pulled out of the three (or if L5S1, two) stab incisions. Subcuticular closure is then
possible (fig. 9). The entire process can be repeated on the opposite side, though some
surgeons may perform unilateral fixation when the biomechanical goal is to provide a
posterior tension band following ALIF (fig. 10).
Results
Rodts 210
dramroo
rods was 65 min. No complications were reported due to the percutaneous
technique. There were no cases of implant failure during the initial follow-up.
Lefkowitz et al. [6] also reported on their experience using percutaneous
pedicle screw fixation following minimally invasive posterior lumbar interbody
fusion (PLIF). This latter technique was performed through endoscopic tubular
retractors but with the use of the operating microscope or surgical loupes. Six
patients underwent this technique. The indications were spondylolisthesis or
degenerative disc disease. One dural tear was reported but was not related to the
screw technique (it occurred during the PLIF technique). The average operating
time for the entire procedure was 6 h 45 min. The average blood loss was
183 ml. The average duration of hospitalization was 2.3 days.
Rodts [7] presented preliminary data of 5 patients who underwent unilat
eral posterior percutaneous pedicle screw fixation following ALIF. The indica
tion for surgery was spondylolisthesis in 4 patients and recurrent disc
herniation in a fifth. All patients received unilateral instrumentation alone.
Follow-up ranged from 10 to 22 months. Solid arthrodesis has been achieved in
all patients. Postoperative CT scans were performed showing satisfactory screw
placement in all screws except one. One S1 screw had 3 mm of lateral cortical
perforation of no clinical significance.
Conclusion
References
1 Wiesner L, Kothe R, Ruther W: Anatomic evaluation of two different techniques for the percuta
neous insertion of pedicle screws in the lumbar spine. Spine 1999;24:15991603.
2 Lowery GL, Kulkarni SS: Posterior percutaneous spine instrumentation. Eur Spine J 2000;9:
S126S130.
3 Magerl F: External skeletal fixation of the lower thoracic and the lumbar spine; in Uhtoff HK,
Stahl E (eds): Current Concepts of External Fixation of Fractures. Berlin, Springer, 1982,
pp 353366.
4 Lefkowitz M, Foley KT: Percutaneous pedicle fixation for spondylolisthesis. Annual Meeting of
the AANS/CNS Joint Section on Disorders of the Spine and Peripheral Nerves, Orlando, 2002.
5 Nockels R, et al: Percutaneous pedicle screw fixation. Annual Meeting of the AANS/CNS Joint
Section on Disorders of the Spine and Peripheral Nerves, Orlando, 2002.
6 Lefkowitz M, Palmer S, Foley KT: Percutaneous pedicle fixation following minimally-invasive
PLIF. 2002 Annual Meeting of the AANS/CNS Joint Section on Disorders of the Spine and
Peripheral Nerves, Orlando, 2002.
7 Rodts GE: Unilateral percutaneous lumbar pedicle screw/rod fixation following ALIF. Global
Spine Meeting, Mexico, 2002.
8 Tribus CB, Belanger TA, Zdeblick TA: The effect of operative position and short-segment fusion
on maintenance of sagittal alignment of the lumbar spine. Spine 1999;24/1:5861.
9 Zuckerman JF, Zdeblick TA, Bailey SA, et al: Instrumented laparoscopic spinal fusion:
Preliminary results. Spine 1995;20:20292034.
10 Yuan HA, Garfin SG, Dickman CA, Mardjetko SM: A historical cohort study of pedicle screw
fixation in thoracic, lumbar and sacral spine fusions. Spine 1999;19(suppl 20):2279S2296S.
11 Foley KT, Gupta SK: Percutaneous pedicle screw fixation of the lumbar spine: Preliminary
results. J Neurosurg 2002;97:712.
Rodts 212
dramroo
Haid RW Jr, Subach BR, Rodts GE Jr (eds): Advances in Spinal Stabilization.
The terms scoliosis, kyphosis, and lordosis were first coined by the Greek
physician Galen in the second century AD [1]. Since that time, significant
advances have occurred in the classification and management of patients with
spinal deformities.
Early physicians attempted to correct thoracolumbar deformities with non-
operative treatments. Hippocrates, and later Galen, unsuccessfully used longitu
dinal traction to try to pull the deformed spine back into alignment [2]. Ambrose
Pare was the first physician to use an orthosis to brace a scoliotic patient
(approximately 1,500 AD). Pare soon realized that bracing was not useful once
a patient had reached skeletal maturity [1].
During the past several centuries, more sophisticated and effective non-
operative treatment modalities for spinal deformity have been developed.
Evaluation of Deformity
dramroo
Anterior superior iliac spine
Medial malleolus
Umbilicus
Fig. 1. Measurement of leg length from the umbilicus or the anterior superior iliac
spine to the medial malleolus.
History
The patients medical and family history should be documented.
Documentation of the age of onset of the deformity and the rate of progression
of the deformity are important factors that may influence treatment. Since the
rate of curve progression often accelerates after puberty, the age of onset of
menarche should also be noted. In addition, since spinal deformities can be
inherited, it is important to identify all relatives with deformity and to attempt
to classify the type of deformity and the rate of progression of the deformity in
family members.
Physical Examination
Initially, a global survey is performed to evaluate overall spinal balance.
Obvious curvatures are noted. Pelvic obliquities and abnormal skin folds are
often seen with moderate to severe scoliotic curvatures. In the pediatric popu
lation, secondary sex characteristics are also noted. Additionally, in scoliotic
patients, leg lengths are measured and discrepancies are noted. Leg lengths can
be measured either from the umbilicus or the anterior superior iliac spine to the
medial malleolus (fig. 1). In addition, overall coronal balance can be quantified
in the upright position by dropping a plumb line from the C7 spinous process
(fig. 2). Normally the line should extend down the intergluteal crease.
Patients with scoliotic curvatures may be in overall coronal balance if their
secondary curves are of sufficient magnitude to recenter C7 over the inter-
gluteal crease in the coronal plane. Patients are asked to perform side bends to
assess if their curves are flexible or rigid.
Mummaneni/Ondra/Sasso 214
dramroo
Fig. 2. C7 plumb line. Normally line
should fall into intergluteal crease indicating
coronal plane balance. The plumb line in this
illustration falls to the right of the intergluteal
crease indicating coronal plane imbalance.
Radiographic Evaluation
Standard radiographic evaluation for deformity begins with standing full
length (36 inch) posterior-anterior (P/A) and lateral spine x-rays. In patients
who cannot stand, recumbent x-rays are acceptable. The flexibility of the
patients scoliotic curve is evaluated with recumbent side-bending x-rays. Side-
bending x-rays are taken in the recumbent position in order to avoid locking the
facet joints during the bending motion. In patients who do not have adequate
muscle mass to perform side bends, a manual push may be administered during
the x-ray.
Scoliosis x-rays differ from nonscoliosis x-rays in several ways. First of all,
they are shot in the P/A direction in order to minimize the radiation dose to the
Mummaneni/Ondra/Sasso 216
dramroo
5
2 3
4
1
Fig. 4. The Risser classification (grades 05) is used to quantify skeletal maturity.
Risser grade 1 patients have ossified only 25% of their iliac apophysis. Risser grade
4 patients have ossified 100% of their iliac apophysis, but have not fused their iliac wing to
their ileum. Risser grade 5 patients are skeletally mature and have ossified their entire iliac
apophysis and fused their iliac wing to the ileum.
breast tissue in adolescent girls. Secondly, scoliosis x-rays are placed on the
x-ray viewer in the opposite orientation from other x-rays. The reader looks at
scoliosis x-rays as if he is looking at the patients back, i.e. the right side of the
x-ray is on the right side of the viewer.
In younger patients, special attention is paid to the pelvis on the P/A x-ray
to assess skeletal maturity. In 1958, Risser [3] noted that the growth of the ver
tebral body endplate parallels the ossification of the iliac apophysis. The Risser
classification (grades 05) is used to quantify skeletal maturity. Risser grade
1 patients have ossified only 25% of their iliac apophysis. Risser grade 4 patients
have ossified 100% of their iliac apophysis but have not fused their iliac wing
to their ileum. Risser grade 5 patients are skeletally mature and have ossified
their entire iliac apophysis and fused their iliac wing to the ileum (fig. 4).
Furthermore, the pelvic x-ray is examined to see if the triradiate acetabular
cartilage is still open (indicating skeletal immaturity).
The lateral x-rays are inspected to assess overall sagittal balance.
Normally, a plumb line dropped from the posterior vertebral body of C7 should
pass through a point within 2.5 cm of the posterosuperior corner of S1. If the
plumb line passes more than 2.5 cm anterior to this point, then the patient is
noted to have a positive sagittal imbalance. Likewise, if the plumb line passes
more than 2.5 cm posterior to this point, then the patient is noted have a nega
tive sagittal imbalance.
The P/A x-rays are evaluated to assess coronal balance and rotatory defor
mity. Overall coronal balance is assessed by dropping a plumb line from the C7
spinous process. Normally, this line should pass through the midline of the sacrum.
Mummaneni/Ondra/Sasso 218
dramroo
Convex side Concave side
T11
Wide
En
dv
Wide er
T1 tebra
2
L1
Wide Cobb
angle
L2
Wide Cobb
angle
L3
Wide
L4
bra
verte
End Wide
L5
Fig. 6. Measurement of the Cobb angle. End vertebrae are the last levels that are tilted
into the curve concavity. A line is drawn from the superior endplate of the superior end ver
tebral body, and another line is drawn from the inferior endplate of the inferior vertebral
body. The angle of the intersection of these lines is the Cobb angle.
Curve Measurement
Scoliosis x-rays are evaluated to establish the number of curves, the location
of the curve(s), the direction of the curve(s), and the magnitude of the curve(s).
When multiple scoliotic curves are present, the major curve is defined as the
largest, rigid curve. Minor curves are compensatory curves that are created to
try to return to overall spinal balance. Minor curves are smaller than the major
curve and usually are flexible on side-bending x-rays.
The magnitude of each coronal plane curve is quantified through the Cobb
angle measurement. To measure the Cobb angle, the physician identifies the
end vertebrae of the curve on the P/A x-ray. End vertebrae are the last levels
that are tilted into the curve concavity. A line is drawn from the superior end-
plate of the superior end vertebral body, and another line is drawn from the infe
rior endplate of the inferior vertebral body. The angle of the intersection of
these lines is the Cobb angle (fig. 6).
Adult Scoliosis
Adult scoliosis has two primary etiologies: adolescent idiopathic scoliosis
(which has progressed after skeletal maturity) and degenerative adult-onset
(de novo) scoliosis.
Mummaneni/Ondra/Sasso 220
dramroo
Adult patients with progressive adolescent idiopathic scoliosis typically
become symptomatic in the fourth and fifth decades of life. These patients are
usually female with thoracic or thoracolumbar junction curves. The most fre
quent presenting complaint in this patient population is back pain (lumbar more
common than thoracic), and the etiology of the back pain may be multifactor
ial. Causes of back pain in this population include muscle fatigue, facet
arthropathy, radiculopathy from foraminal compression, and lumbar degenera
tive disc disease. Other presenting complaints in this population include
cosmetic deformity or, rarely, cardiopulmonary dysfunction.
For patients presenting with pain, the surgeon must deduce the cause of the
pain via the patients history, exam, and/or diagnostic testing. Fatigue-related back
pain, for example, usually occurs on the convex side of the curve, is absent in the
morning, worsens as the day progresses, and resolves with rest. It is often allevi
ated with physical therapy (strengthening of the back and abdominal muscles).
If patients fail physical therapy, then bracing may be tried to reduce the workload
on the muscles (bracing in the adult does not prevent curve progression).
Patients with facet arthropathy, on the other hand, often have pain on the
concave side of their curve or in the lower lumbar spine. This pain is also activ
ity related. Facet arthropathy can be confirmed by, and effectively treated by,
facet joint injections.
Patients with thoracic or lumbar radiculopathy can be diagnosed by their
history of radiating pain. The diagnosis can be confirmed by selective nerve
root sleeve injection. The selective nerve root sleeve injections can be periodi
cally repeated to give long-term pain relief.
Patients with degenerative disc disease causing mechanical low back pain
should undergo a trial of physical therapy to strengthen their low back and
abdominal muscles. This often alleviates their pain because these muscle
groups can then function to decrease the workload of the lumbar discs. If phys
ical therapy is ineffective, then further evaluation can be done with discography.
If the discogram correlates with their pain and with disc degeneration seen on
MRI, then lumbar fusion may be considered (if the patient is not osteoporotic).
For scoliotic patients presenting with pulmonary limitations, one key
treatment option is cessation of smoking.
In general, initial management of adults with progressive idiopathic scol
iosis should be nonoperative. Most patients will respond to the measures above
in combination with oral nonsteroidal anti-inflammatory medications.
Kyphosis
Normal thoracic kyphosis ranges from 20 to 40. Hyperkyphosis is a sagit
tal plane deformity with excessive flexion of the thoracic spine. Hyperkyphosis
is subclassified as either postural or structural (fig. 3).
Postural kyphosis is due to poor posture, and the patient can consciously
correct the curve by standing up straight. Postural kyphosis is characterized
by a smooth, rounding pattern in the thoracic spine. There is no gibbus on
forward flexion. For patients with cosmetic issues related to their postural
kyphosis, we recommend physical therapy with back strengthening exercises to
improve posture. No operative intervention is indicated.
Structural kyphosis, on the other hand, cannot be consciously corrected by
the patient. Often, a gibbus is seen when the patient is asked to flex forward, and
there is often a sharp angular pattern to the kyphosis on x-ray. Structural kypho
sis can either be primary or secondary. The most common cause of primary struc
tural kyphosis is Scheuermanns disease (juvenile kyphosis). Scheuermanns
disease is defined as three consecutive levels of at least 5 of segmental kyphosis
(anterior wedging) at each level [11]. The etiology of Scheuermanns disease is
unknown; however, there does appear to be a familial occurrence. Nonoperative
treatment for Scheuermanns disease is indicated for progression of the kyphosis
beyond 40 (but under 70) in a skeletally immature patient (Risser 14). For
these patients, an underarm, hyperextension, thoracolumbar orthosis is often
satisfactory to halt progression of the kyphosis [12, 13].
Mummaneni/Ondra/Sasso 222
dramroo
Secondary structural kyphosis, on the other hand, has an underlying
pathological process. The most common etiologies include multiple level degen
erative disc disease, vertebral body fracture or tumor, or prior multilevel laminec
tomy. Multilevel thoracic degenerative disc disease can result in thoracic
hyperkyphosis, whereas multilevel lumbar degenerative disc disease is the most
common cause of lumbar flat backs. Normally, lumbar discs are taller anteri
orly than posteriorly and thus create lumbar lordosis. As the lumbar discs
dehydrate, the lumbar spine loses this normal lordosis and becomes straight.
The patient often loses overall spinal sagittal balance as a result and tries to
compensate by flexing at the hips and knees. Patients with secondary structural
kyphosis are often older adults, and the typical presenting complaint is back pain.
The physician must, once again, determine the cause of the pain. The pain may be
due to muscle fatigue, which typically worsens as the day progresses. Pain related
to muscle fatigue can often be effectively treated by back strengthening physical
therapy. Another treatment modality is daytime bracing with an underarm thora
columbar orthosis in those unable to perform back strengthening exercises. The
orthosis can share the load with the posterior spinal musculature and reduce mus
cle fatigue and pain. However, in the skeletally mature patient, an orthosis will not
prevent progression of the kyphosis. In addition, the orthosis can contribute to fur
ther weakening and atrophy of the lumbar musculature by shielding these muscles
from spinal loads.
Pain may be due to degenerative disc disease (the workup and treatment
have been previously mentioned and will not be repeated here). Pain may be
due to facet arthropathy. This pain also tends to worsen as the day progresses.
Facet joint injections can be both diagnostic and therapeutic for this problem.
Conclusion
For the majority of patients with mild or moderate spinal deformities, ini
tial evaluation and a course (or several courses) of the appropriate nonsurgical
treatment are often satisfactory to alleviate symptoms.
For those patients who fail to have relief of their symptoms with conserva
tive treatment, and for those patients who have severe deformities, surgical
intervention is often necessary. Part 2 will focus on the indications for surgical
treatment and the options for surgical treatment of spinal deformity [14].
Acknowledgments
We are grateful to Drew Imhulse and Tom Fletcher for assistance with the radiographic
images in the figures. We are grateful to Sherry Ballenger for editorial assistance.
The following authors are consultants for Medtronic Sofamor Danek: Stephen L. Ondra,
MD and Rick C. Sasso, MD.
References
1 Ogilvie JW: Historical aspects of scoliosis; in Lonstein JE, Bradford DS, Winter RB, Ogilvie JW
(eds): Moes Textbook of Scoliosis and Other Spinal Deformities. Philadelphia, Saunders, 1995,
pp 13.
2 Huebert HT: Scoliosis. A brief history. Manit Med Rev 1967;47:452456.
3 Risser JC: The iliac apophysis: An invaluable sign in the management of scoliosis. Clin Orthop
1958;11:111.
4 Nash CL Jr, Moe JH: A study of vertebral rotation. J Bone Joint Surg Am 1969;51:223229.
5 Lonstein JE, Carlson JM: The prediction of curve progression in untreated idiopathic scoliosis
during growth. J Bone Joint Surg Am 1984;66:10611071.
6 Lonstein JE, Bjorklund S, Wanninger MH, Nelson RP: Voluntary school screening for scoliosis in
Minnesota. J Bone Joint Surg Am 1982;64:481488.
7 Nachemson A, Peterson L: Effectiveness of treatment with a brace in girls who have adolescent
idiopathic scoliosis. J Bone Joint Surg Am 1995;177:815822.
8 Weinstein SL, Ponseti IV: Curve progression in idiopathic scoliosis: Long-term follow-up. J Bone
Joint Surg Am 1983;65:447.
9 Weinstein SL: Natural history. Spine 1999;24:2592.
10 Ascani E, Bartolozzi P, Logroscino CA, Marchetti PG, Ponte A, Savini R, Travaglini F, Binazzi R,
Di Silvestre M: Natural history of untreated idiopathic scoliosis after skeletal maturity. Spine
1986;11:784789.
11 Sorensen KH: Scheuermanns Juvenile Kyphosis. Copenhagen, Munksgaard, 1964.
12 Sachs BL, Bradford DS, Winter RB, Lonstein J, Moe J, Willson S: Scheuermann kyphosis. Follow-up
of Milwaukee-brace treatment. J Bone Joint Surg Am 1987;69/1:5057.
13 Murray PM, Weinstein SL, Spratt KF: The natural history and long-term follow-up of Scheuermanns
kyphosis. J Bone Joint Surg Am 1993;75/2:236.
14 Mummaneni PV, Ondra SL, Sasso RC: Thoracolumbar deformity advances. 2. Operative treatment
of thoracolumbar deformity. Prog Neurol Surg. Basel, Karger, 2003, pp 225239.
Praveen V. Mummaneni, MD
Assistant Professor, Department of Neurosurgery, The Emory Clinic
550 Peachtree St., Suite 806, Atlanta, GA 30308 (USA)
Tel. 1 404 686 8101, Fax 1 404 686 4805, E-Mail [email protected]
Mummaneni/Ondra/Sasso 224
dramroo
Haid RW Jr, Subach BR, Rodts GE Jr (eds): Advances in Spinal Stabilization.
dramroo
The ends of the curve are defined as the vertebrae that are both stable and
neutral. The stable vertebra is the end vertebra that is most closely bisected by
the center sacral line. The neutral vertebra is the end vertebra that is the least
rotated. Usually the stable vertebra is also the neutral vertebra, but if they do
not correspond then fusion to the stable vertebra (not the neutral vertebra) is
recommended [3].
This will give the surgeon a good idea of the amount of correction needed
to reestablish spinal balance. Lateral bending films are useful to identify struc
tural (usually rigid thoracic curves) and compensatory curves (usually flexible,
lower magnitude, lumbar curves without pedicle rotation). In addition, the size
of the rib hump should also be measured, and the surgeon can consider thora
coplasty for significant rib hump deformity.
Curve Classification
Classification of AIS curves is important because the selection of fusion
levels is dependent on the classification. Over the past few decades, the King
classification system has been the most commonly used system to classify AIS
curves. Recently, however, Lenke et al. [4] described a more comprehensive and
descriptive classification system for AIS.
We prefer to use the Lenke classification system for several reasons.
The King system only describes curves in the coronal plane and does not take
sagittal balance into account. In addition, interobserver variability in classifi
cation with the King system is high. The Lenke system, on the other hand, takes
into account sagittal alignment with a sagittal modifier. In addition, the Lenke
system is highly descriptive and uses a three-tiered classification scheme
(6 curve types, lumbar spine modifier, and sagittal thoracic modifier) (fig. 1) [4].
The most frequent curve types with the Lenke system were found to be type 1
(main thoracic curve) and type 2 (double thoracic curve) with the most frequent
curve classifications found to be types 1AN, 1BN, and 2AN [4].
Surgical Correction
The Lenke classification system can be used to predict which levels should
be instrumented to correct AIS [5]. For type 1 curves, only the main thoracic
curve should be instrumented. For type 2 curves, both the proximal and main
thoracic curves should be fused. For type 3 curves (double major), both the
main thoracic and the thoracolumbar/lumbar curves should be fused. For type 4
curves (triple major), all three curves should be instrumented.
Surgical treatment for AIS is usually reserved until the patient is close to
skeletal maturity. If the patient is not near skeletal maturity, then the patient
may be at risk for a crankshaft phenomenon in the years following surgery.
The crankshaft is due to continued growth from the vertebral endplates while
Mummaneni/Ondra/Sasso 226
dramroo
No to minimal lumbar curve
1A 2A 3A 4A
Lumbar spine
modifier
Moderate lumbar curve
1B 2B 3B 4B
Large lumbar curve
1C 2C 3C 4C 5C 6C
Fig. 1. Artists illustration of the Lenke classification system for scoliosis. The Lenke
system is highly descriptive and uses a three-tiered classification scheme (6 curve types,
a lumbar spine modifier, and a sagittal thoracic modifier). TL Thoracolumbar; L lumbar;
MT main thoracic.
the posterior tension band is secured by instrumentation; the spine then crank
shafts from side to side to accommodate the vertebral body growth.
In the past few decades, hook-rod instrumentation has been used success
fully for the correction of AIS. In the 1990s, however, pedicle screw-rod
Posterior Approach
The classic operation performed for a structural right thoracic curve in an
adolescent is a selective thoracic fusion. Classically, a selective thoracic fusion
is maintained by distraction with hook-rod instrumentation on the concave side
of the curve and compression with instrumentation on the convex side of the
curve [6, 7].
Initially, the thoracic curve is instrumented with hooks on the concave
side; a rod is attached to the concave hooks and a rod rotation maneuver is
performed to correct the curve (i.e. attach a concave rod to the hooks and then
rotate the rod until it is straight in the sagittal plane). On the concave side,
up-going pedicle hooks are typically placed at the superior end of the curve, and
down-going laminar hooks are typically placed at the inferior end of the curve.
This hook pattern allows for distraction on the rod, which serves to maintain the
correction after a rod rotation maneuver. On the convex side, a claw is placed
at the superior end of the curve (the claw consists of down-going hooks above
and up-going hooks at the next level below), an up-going hook is placed at the
apex of the curve, and down-going hooks are placed inferiorly. This hook pat
tern allows for compression on the rod in order to maintain curve correction on
the convex side of the curve. The compensatory lumbar curve is not instru
mented and will typically correct to normal when the structural thoracic curve
is straightened [8].
Alternative posterior fusion options include hybrid hook-screw-rod
systems, hook-endplate screw systems, or pure pedicle screw-rod systems.
In the hybrid system, hooks are placed superiorly (where the pedicle diameters
are smaller) and screws are placed inferiorly (where the pedicle diameters are
larger). In the pedicle hook-endplate screw system, a pedicle hook is placed and
then anchored to an endplate screw; this rigid fixation technique is similar to
pedicle screws in pullout strength. In pure pedicle screw systems, no hooks
are used; instead, pedicle screws are placed in lieu of the hooks. In all three
systems, a rod rotation maneuver is initially done on the concave side of the
curve to correct the curve.
Mummaneni/Ondra/Sasso 228
dramroo
When we place thoracic pedicle screws, we have found the following sur
gical nuances to be helpful. We locate the entry point for thoracic pedicle
screws by using a high-speed burr to decorticate the surface of the thoracic
facet overlying the area of the pedicle. Once this mild decortication has been
done, a blush of blood is usually noticeable, and this blush marks the entry to
the pedicle. This blush of red arises from the cancellous bone at the center of
the pedicle, which tends to bleed when uncovered. The surrounding facet area
does not tend to blush with this maneuver. The surgeon can reliably establish
the pedicle entry point through this technique.
The typical location of the pedicle with respect to the thoracic transverse
process and facet has been elucidated by Lenke et al. [9].
One word of caution is in order, however. If the central portion of the pedi
cle is corticated, then this blush technique cannot be used, as there is no can
cellous bleeding bone. In this case, we recommend the surgeon perform a
laminoforaminotomy to feel the medial, superior, and inferior walls of the pedi
cle to guide the screw placement [10].
Once the entry point has been established, there are three options we use to
establish a pathway through the pedicle for the pedicle screw. The first method we
use entails tapping the pedicle from the entry point with a 3.5-mm tap from the
VERTEX posterior cervical set (Medtronic Sofamor Danek, Memphis, Tenn.,
USA). This tap has fine cutting flutes and with minimal downward pressure, the
tap has a tendency to find the appropriate trajectory for screw placement by cut
ting through the cancellous portion of the pedicle without violating the cortical
pedicle walls. The screw can then be placed through this trajectory.
The second option is to use the thoracic pedicle probe recently created by
Lenke et al. [9]. This small tap is ideal for the thoracic pedicles. It has a small
angled end, and this end is initially placed through the pedicle entry point facing
laterally (in order to avoid medial cortical wall violation and spinal canal penetra
tion). After a depth of 15 mm (marked on the tap itself), the probe is then turned
medially to enter into the vertebral body and to avoid lateral wall breakout from
the vertebral body. It is important to note that after the first 15 mm, the probe is
beyond the spinal canal in most patients, and the risk of spinal cord injury is
minimized during the first 15 mm by the laterally directed angle of the probe [9].
We avoid drilling down the pedicle as cortical breakthrough can occur with
the drill. However, when the pedicle is corticated, then drilling becomes a
necessity (the third option). We guide our drill trajectory by feeling the outer
walls of the pedicle after performing a laminoforaminotomy. When the pedicles
are too small to accommodate 4.5-mm screws, several options should be con
sidered. First, by using a 3.5-mm tap (we prefer to use the one available on
the VERTEX posterior cervical system), we establish a pathway through the
pedicle into the vertebral body. Then we use a 4.5-mm tap to dilate the pedicle.
ST
Fig. 2. Artists illustration of the difference between the anatomic (AT) and the
straightforward (ST) trajectories for thoracic pedicle screw placement. The thoracic pedicle
screws can either be placed parallel to the endplates (straightforward trajectory), or they can
be placed parallel to the axis of the pedicle itself (anatomic trajectory).
In adolescents, the pedicle often dilates with this successive tapping, and this
allows for placement of a 4.5-mm screw.
Another option for dealing with a small pedicle is to use the in-out-in
technique for screw placement [11]. In this technique, the screw enters the pedicle
and then is purposely placed through the lateral wall of the pedicle and engages
the bone of the transverse process and rib head. The screw subsequently reen
ters the pedicle more anteriorly and ends in the vertebral body [12, 13].
The surgeon should keep in mind that the pedicle on the concave side of
the curve may be smaller than the pedicle on the convex side. Consequently,
different screw widths may be needed for the contralateral pedicles of the same
level in scoliotic patients [14].
Use of fluoroscopy can be helpful in establishing the appropriate sagittal
plane angulation of the pedicle screw. Thoracic pedicle screws can either be
placed parallel to the endplates (straightforward trajectory), or they can be
placed parallel to the axis of the pedicle itself (anatomic trajectory) (fig. 2).
When placed parallel to the axis of the pedicle (anatomic trajectory), a longer
screw can be used, and the tip of the screw is directed at the anterior, inferior
vertebral endplate [1517].
Anterior Approach
Another alternative is to perform the correction through an anterior
approach by releasing the anterior longitudinal ligament, debriding the discs
anteriorly, packing the disc spaces with bone graft harvested from a rib, placing
Mummaneni/Ondra/Sasso 230
dramroo
vertebral body screws, and derotating the spine with a connected rod. This can
be done either through a video-assisted thoracoscopic surgery (VATS), via an
open thoracotomy, or via a mini-open thoracotomy, which is a hybrid tech
nique utilizing a small thoracotomy inferiorly and VATS superiorly [18, 19].
In patients who are not near skeletal maturity, an anterior operation may be
required to release the spine anteriorly and remove the growing vertebral end-
plates. The surgeon can choose to perform only an anterior release and epiph
ysiodesis with a subsequent posterior instrumented procedure, or he can
perform an anterior release, derotation, and fusion through a single anterior
approach.
The anterior approach for derotation and fusion has advantages and disad
vantages. VATS offers the advantages of decreased blood loss, sparing of the
posterior muscular tension band, and a smaller surgical scar. However, VATS
requires a lung takedown (with subsequent chest tube placement) and entails a
longer operative time (often double the time of a posterior operation).
Anterior derotation and fusion procedures typically do not achieve the
same degree of curve correction that posterior procedures do; this is likely due
to the limitations in the number of segments that can be accessed via an ante
rior approach. When patients are hyperkyphotic the anterior approach is not
possible, as access to the anterior vertebral bodies is limited. In addition, long-
term follow-up of anterior derotation and fusion procedures is currently lacking.
Consequently, a posterior derotation and fusion operation is still the gold-
standard operation for correction of AIS.
Adult Scoliosis
Adult Patients with Progressive AIS
The indications for surgery in this patient population are curve progression
greater than 5 in a single year, back pain that is not relieved by conservative
measures, pulmonary compromise from severe curvature, and unacceptable
cosmetic deformity. Of these, the two most common indications are unrelent
ing back pain and cosmetic deformity.
Surgical Correction
The principles for surgical correction of adult patients with AIS are simi
lar to those for adolescents with AIS. The curve can be evaluated and classified
by the Lenke system. The instrumentation pattern is dependent upon the curve
classification.
There are, however, two main differences between treating AIS in adults
versus adolescents. First, the rate of pseudoarthrosis is higher for adults than for
adolescents. Consequently, adults may need both anterior and posterior surgery
to achieve a solid fusion. The anterior approach is often required in long curves
to release the anterior longitudinal ligament and incise disc spaces to allow for
a rigid curve to be corrected. The disc spaces can then be packed with structural
graft to promote fusion, and a subsequent posterior procedure can be performed
to instrument and correct the curvature.
The second major difference between adults and adolescents with AIS is
that adults often have significant disc degeneration and spondylosis in the
Mummaneni/Ondra/Sasso 232
dramroo
lumbar spine. Stopping a long segment fusion at a stable and neutral vertebra
in the mid lumbar spine may not be appropriate in the face of significant lum
bar spondylosis and degenerative disc disease (DDD). Patients with significant
lumbar spondylosis and DDD may have progression of the spondylosis or sig
nificant low back pain from accelerated disc degeneration due to the greater
loads on these segments following a long segment fusion above. Consequently,
the need for extension of the fusion to the sacrum is greater in adults than it is
in adolescents. However, if there is no significant lumbar spondylosis or disc
degeneration, then stopping the fusion in the mid lumbar spine is appropriate.
Surgical Correction
In the subgroup of patients who are in overall spinal balance, there are two
surgical treatment options. First, if the patient suffers from primarily radicular
symptoms, then a unilateral Wiltse approach and decompression (posterolateral
approach between the multifidus and longissimus muscles to perform an
extraforaminal nerve root decompression) on the concave side of the curve are
often sufficient to provide relief from radicular pain [21]. The advantage of this
option is that the posterior ligamentous tension band is left intact and bony
removal of the posterior column is kept to a minimum. Only the lateral portion
of the facet joints is removed and the roof of the neural foramen is opened from
lateral to medial.
If the patient, who is in overall spinal balance, is suffering from both low
back and radicular pain, then another surgical treatment option is needed. For
these patients, we recommend foraminal decompression on the concave side of
the curve with an in situ instrumented fusion with pedicle screw-rod instru
mentation. The foraminal decompression from a standard midline posterior
approach will address the radicular symptoms. The fusion will relieve the low
back pain (which is likely secondary to DDD and lumbar spondylosis). We
always use autograft bone harvested from the iliac crest to establish the fusion.
Mummaneni/Ondra/Sasso 234
dramroo
performed, then the risk of pseudoarthrosis is high in this elderly patient
population.
A subsequent posterior approach with a coronal plane wedge osteotomy of
the convex facets is performed (i.e. the convex facets are removed from the pedi
cle above the neural foramen to the pedicle below the neural foramen). The
wedge-shaped osteotomy of the convex side of the curve prevents compression of
the exiting nerve roots on the convex side. This osteotomy is extended beyond the
midline and includes the convex side of the laminae in order to avoid thecal sac
compression when the convex side is compressed. Pedicle screws are then placed
at all levels from the superior to the inferior stable vertebrae of the lumbar scoli
otic curve. Rods are connected to the screws and the convex side of the curve is
compressed while the concave side is distracted, and the curve is straightened.
If the surgeon wishes to perform the entire operation from a posterior
approach, then multilevel transforaminal lumbar interbody fusions can be per
formed and Pyramesh cages filled with autograft can be placed into the inter-
body space through this approach. Fusion to the sacrum is avoided if the
inferior stable vertebra is at L4 or above and if the L4/5 and L5/S1 discs are in
good condition. If the lumbosacral junction is not fused, then additional curve
compensation is possible for the patient. However, if the curve extends to L5 or
if the low lumbar discs are significantly degenerated, then fusion to the sacrum
is often needed. There are several options for extension of the fusion to the
sacrum. First of all, S1 (and S2) pedicle screws can be placed. However, the
sacral pedicles have large cancellous centers, and they often do not allow for
solid screw purchase. Sacral pedicle screws have greater pullout strengths if
they are bicortical, and lateral fluoroscopy can assist with bicortical placement.
Long segment fusions to the sacrum are subject to large cantilever loads,
which can lead to pullout of sacral pedicle screws, sacral fractures, and lum
bosacral pseudoarthrosis. Consequently, some surgeons elect to supplement
sacral pedicle screws with intrasacral rods, transacral rods, and/or iliac screw
fixation [22, 23]. Iliac screw fixation can be hindered by harvesting posterior
iliac crest bone graft. However, the harvest of posterior iliac crest bone graft
does not completely preclude the placement of iliac crest screws [24].
Kyphosis
Surgical treatment of kyphosis can be considered if there is a rigid thoracic
or thoracolumbar kyphotic curve greater than 6070 in either the adolescent or
the adult. Curves of 6070 are often cosmetically deforming, but they usually
do not cause significant cardiopulmonary symptoms. However, these curves
can cause intractable back pain that is not responsive to conservative treatment
measures. Curves over 8090, on the other hand, can cause cardiopulmonary
compromise and surgical correction is definitely indicated.
Bony resection
Winn after Bridwell
Surgical Correction
Surgical correction of large, structural thoracic or thoracolumbar curves
can be performed through a posterior approach or a combined anterior and
posterior approach. Correction through an anterior only approach is difficult
because the severe thoracic kyphosis limits the surgeons access to the anterior
thoracic spine.
Curves of 6070 can be treated via a posterior only approach, especially if
the curves are flexible. The treatment strategy for these curves is to expose the
ends of the curve, and then to either perform a pedicle subtraction osteotomy
(PSO) or multilevel posterior closing wedge osteotomies (multiple Smith
Petersen osteotomies). PSO is useful for a focal thoracic kyphosis (i.e. thoracic
wedge compression fracture) because with PSO, the majority of the correction is
performed over a single segment. The technique involves removing a large wedge
of the posterior and middle columns (including the pedicle) of the vertebral body.
The remainder of the posterior and middle columns is then approximated by
pulling together pedicle screws above and below the osteotomy level. The ante
rior column of the PSO level acts as the fulcrum for this correction (fig. 4), and
up to 30 of correction can be achieved with a single level of PSO [25].
Prior to approximating the remainder of the posterior and middle columns
in PSO, a Z-plasty of the underlying dura may be needed to avoid buckling of
the dura into the spinal canal. We prefer to perform PSO below the conus to
avoid injury to the spinal cord.
Mummaneni/Ondra/Sasso 236
dramroo
Preoperative Postoperative
Bony resection
Winn after Bridwell
Conclusion
Surgical correction of spinal deformity has advanced rapidly over the past
decade. Correction of severe scoliotic and kyphotic deformities can now be
performed with low mortality rates. However, the morbidity rates for major
deformity corrections remain very high. New advances will likely blend more
minimally invasive techniques with the current instrumentation systems in an
Acknowledgments
We are grateful to Drew Imhulse and Tom Fletcher for assistance with the radiographic
images in the figures, to Sherry Ballenger for editorial assistance, and to Bill Winn for assis
tance with the illustrations. We thank Medtronic Sofamor Danek for permission to use
several of the illustrations.
Disclosure Statement
The following authors are consultants for Medtronic Sofamor Danek: Stephen L.
Ondra, MD and Rick C. Sasso, MD.
References
Mummaneni/Ondra/Sasso 238
dramroo
14 Liljenqvist UR, Link TM, Halm HFH: Morphometric analysis of thoracic and lumbar vertebrae in
idiopathic scoliosis. Spine 2000;22:12471253.
15 Klemme WR, Belmont PJ, Polly DW: Transpedicular thoracic screws: General concepts and inser
tion technique using fluoroscopic guidance. Semin Spine Surg 2002;14/1:4347.
16 McCormack BM, Benzel EC, Adams MS, Baldwin NG, Rupp FW, Maher DJ: Anatomy of the
thoracic pedicle. Neurosurgery 1995;37:303308.
17 Kuklo TR, Polly DW: Surgical anatomy of the thoracic pedicle. Semin Spine Surg 2002;14/1:37.
18 Newton PO, Wenger DR, Mubarak SJ, Meyer RS: Anterior release and fusion in pediatric spinal
deformity: A comparison of early outcome and cost of thoracoscopic and open thoracotomy
approaches. Spine 1997;22:13981406.
19 Lenke LG, Rhee J: Adolescent scoliosis: Anterior surgical techniques for adolescent idiopathic
scoliosis. Curr Opin Orthop 2001;12/3:199205.
20 Eck KR, Bridwell KH, Ungacta FF, Riew KD, Lapp MA, Lenke LG, Baldus C, Blanke K:
Complications and results of long adult deformity fusions down to L4, L5, and the sacrum. Spine
2001;26:E182E192.
21 Wiltse LL: The paraspinal sacrospinalis-splitting approach to the lumbar spine. Clin Orthop 1973;
91:4857.
22 Mazda K, Khairouni A, Pennecot GF, Bloch J: The ideal position of sacral transpedicular endplate
screws in Jacksons intrasacral fixation. An anatomic study of 50 sacral specimens. Spine 1998;
23:21232126.
23 Emami A, Deviren V, Berven S, Smith JA, Hu SS, Bradford DS: Outcome and complications of
long fusions to the sacrum in adult spine deformity: Luque-Galveston, combined iliac and sacral
screws, and sacral fixation. Spine 2002;27:776786.
24 Kuklo TR, Bridwell KH, Lewis SJ, Baldus C, Blanke K, Iffrig TM, Lenke LG: Minimum 2-year
analysis of sacropelvic fixation and L5S1 fusion using S1 and iliac screws. Spine 2001;26:
19761983.
25 Kim KT, Suk KS, Cho YJ, Hong GP, Park BJ: Clinical outcome results of pedicle subtraction
osteotomy in ankylosing spondylitis with kyphotic deformity. Spine 2002;27:612618.
26 Smith-Petersen MN, Larson CB, Aufranc OE: Osteotomy of the spine for correction of flexion
deformity in rheumatoid arthritis. Clin Orthop 1969;66:69.
27 Booth KC, Bridwell KH, Lenke LG, Baldus CR, Blanke KM: Complications and predictive
factors for the successful treatment of flatback deformity (fixed sagittal imbalance). Spine 1999;
24:17121720.
Praveen V. Mummaneni, MD
Assistant Professor, Department of Neurosurgery, The Emory Clinic
550 Peachtree St., Suite 806, Atlanta, GA 30308 (USA)
Tel. 1 404 686 8101, Fax 1 404 686 4805, E-Mail [email protected]
Isador Lieberman
The Cleveland Clinic Foundation, Cleveland, Ohio, USA
dramroo
includes bed rest, analgesics, and bracing. This type of medical management,
however, fails to restore spinal alignment, and the lack of mobility itself can
result in secondary complications, including worsening osteoporosis, atelectasis,
pneumonia, deep vein thrombosis, decubitus ulcer, and pulmonary embolism.
An alternative approach is supervised ambulatory mobility by a physiotherapist
plus hydrotherapy [15]. In one third of patients, severe pain, limited mobility,
and poor quality of life persist despite appropriate nonoperative management.
No patient spontaneously achieves a realigned spine, corrected sagittal contour,
or restoration of vertebral height.
Half the patients with metastases to the spine report pain relief after exter
nal beam radiation [31]. Patients with radiosensitive tumors (breast, prostate,
myeloma) typically do well, however radiotherapy does not protect the spine
from progressive osteolytic collapse and presents the treating surgeon with
major concerns regarding postoperative wound healing and bone fusion should
surgery be indicated [32]. Similar concerns exist when considering the use of
chemotherapy to treat various metastases to the spine, although there are new
investigational bisphosphonates which are promising reversal of bone loss [33].
Percutaneous Vertebroplasty
Background
Percutaneous vertebral augmentation (vertebroplasty, PVP) was first
devised by Galibert et al. [16] in 1987, and initially involved the augmenta
tion of the vertebral body with PMMA during open procedures to allow stable
fixation of internal hardware. PVP was first described in the French literature in
1987 [16] but was not performed in the United States until 1994. Originally
targeted for osteolytic metastasis, myeloma, and hemangioma, PVP resulted in
early appreciable pain relief and a low complication rate [7, 16]. Its indications
now include osteoporotic vertebral collapse with chronic pain, expanding further
to include treatment of asymptomatic vertebral collapse and even prophylactic
intervention for at risk vertebral bodies [17]. Nevertheless, the treatment of acute
fractures in ambulatory patients and prophylactic treatment remains controver
sial [18]. In fact, vertebral augmentation itself is somewhat controversial, with
questions concerning a lack of defined indications, expected complications,
outcome measures, and the need for long-term follow-up data [2].
An open question in PVP is the mechanism of pain relief. The most
intuitive explanation involves simple mechanical stabilization of the fracture;
the cement stabilizes vertebral bodies and offloads the facet joints. However,
another possibility is that analgesia results from local chemical, vascular, or
thermal effects of PMMA on nerve endings in surrounding tissue [8, 19].
Supporting this concept is the lack of correlation between cement volume and
pain relief [20, 21]. Further evidence against an effect resulting solely from
mechanical stabilization is the fact that PVP typically does not restore lost ver
tebral body height and therefore does not correct altered biomechanics [1, 18].
Technique
Injection of opacified PMMA is performed via a transpedicular or para
vertebral approach under continuous fluoroscopic guidance to obtain adequate
filling and to avoid PMMA leakage. For complex or high-risk cases, CT and
fluoroscopic guidance are sometimes combined [5, 18]. In routine cases, PVP
can be performed under local anesthesia with slight sedation in less than an
hour [1], although general anesthesia is sometimes required because pain may
Lieberman 242
dramroo
intensify during cement injection [8]. Preceding PMMA injection, intraosseous
venography is often used to determine the filling pattern and identify sites of
potential PMMA leakage (outline the venous drainage pattern, confirm needle
placement within the bony trabeculae, and delineate fractures in the bony
cortex). However, others have dispensed with routine venography [1].
Contraindications to vertebroplasty include coagulopathy, absence of facil
ities to perform emergency decompressive surgery in the event of a complica
tion, and extreme vertebral collapse (6570% reduction in vertebral height)
[8]. However, this last contraindication has been questioned recently [18, 22].
Results
The available clinical studies, mostly European, report pain relief in about
90% of cases treated for osteoporotic fracture, with only infrequent clinically
significant complications (010%), most of them minor [7, 18]. In a series of 80
patients treated with PVP for osteoporotic vertebral collapse, 90% gained imme
diate pain relief [5]. During a follow-up of 1 month to 10 years, only one com
plication was reported: intercostal neuralgia treated by local anesthetic
infiltration. In another prospective study of 45 vertebral body augmentations in
17 osteoporotic patients led to significant and lasting pain reduction during the
1-year follow-up [1]. Although cement leakage occurred in 20% of vertebral bod
ies, none had clinical sequelae. In a retrospective review of 70 augmented verte
brae in 38 consecutive patients with osteoporosis, treatment resulted in pain relief
within 48 h in 36 patients (95%). The pain relief was durable in 34 of the patients
(89%) during a follow-up averaging 18 months. Twenty-four patients (63%) expe
rienced marked to complete pain relief, 12 (32%) moderate relief, and 2 (5%) no
significant change [18]. Of 8 patients suffering malignant neoplasm of the spinal
column and treated with vertebroplasty, 4 (50%) found pain relief in this series
[18]. Cortet et al. [23] studied 16 patients with 20 osteoporotic vertebral com
pression fractures who underwent PVP. This study found a statistically significant
decrease in pain with several standardized scoring systems at all observed time
points during the 6-month follow-up, along with concurrent, significant improve
ment in overall health status. No adverse events and no vertebral fractures
occurred during the follow-up period. Another study of 29 patients with 47
painful osteoporotic vertebral fractures reported a 90% success rate in terms of
significant pain relief immediately after treatment [7]. Two patients sustained rib
fractures during the procedure resulting in pain that subsequently resolved;
otherwise, no clinically significant complications were noted.
Complications
The principal risk of PVP, which involves the forced injection of low-
viscosity PMMA cement into the closed space of the collapsed vertebral body,
Kyphoplasty
Background
Kyphoplasty is a new technique evolved from a marriage of vertebroplasty
with balloon angioplasty. It has a number of potential advantages, including
lower risk of cement extravasation and better restoration of vertebral body
height. A cannula is introduced into the vertebral body, via a transpedicular or
Lieberman 244
dramroo
a b c
Technique
With the patient under general or local anesthesia in prone position on a
radiolucent spinal frame, two C-arms are positioned for anteroposterior and lat
eral fluoroscopic images. Once positioned the C-arms or patient are not moved
to ensure repeatable images throughout the case. Two 3-mm incisions are made
at the vertebral level, parallel to the pedicles in both planes. Then a guide wire
or biopsy needle is advanced into the vertebral body via a transpedicular or
extrapedicular approach, depending on fracture configuration and patients
anatomy. The guide wire is then exchanged for the working cannula using a
series of obturators. Once the working cannula is positioned the surgeon reams
out a corridor to accommodate the IBT and positions IBT under the collapsed
endplate. To deploy the IBT, inflation proceeds slowly under fluoroscopy until
maximum fracture reduction is achieved or the balloon reaches a cortical wall
(see fig. 1). At this point the surgeon deflates and removes the IBT, mixes the
cement, prefills the cement cannulae and allows the cement to partially cure in
Results
Kyphoplasty has been slowly advanced through a few surgical centers par
ticipating in a multicenter study begun in 1999. A phase I efficacy study of 70
consecutive kyphoplasty procedures in 30 patients with painful, progressive
osteoporotic/osteolytic VCFs was recently completed [29]. Mean duration of
symptoms was 5.9 months. Symptomatic levels were identified by correlating
the clinical data with MRI findings. Preoperative and postoperative x-rays were
compared to calculate the percentage height restored. Outcome was further
assessed by comparing the preoperative and latest postoperative survey of
patients self-reported health status using the 36-item Short Form Health Survey
(SF-36) [30]. In 70% of the vertebral bodies, kyphoplasty restored on average
47% of the lost vertebral height (p 0.001). SF-36 scores for bodily pain
(p 0.0001), physical function (p 0.002), and vitality (p 0.001) were
among the subscales that showed substantial and significant improvement.
Complications were infrequent. One patient experienced perioperative pul
monary edema and a myocardial infarction secondary to intraoperative fluid
overload; 2 patients suffered rib fractures due to positioning during the proce
dure. Cement leakage occurred at 6 of 70 treated levels (8.6%); however, there
were no complications that related directly to selection of this technique or to
use of the IBT. In an ongoing evaluation the results of this initial series have
been maintained in the most recent follow-up of over 70 consecutive patients
up to 14 months.
In a second prospective evaluation the safety and efficacy of kyphoplasty in
the treatment of osteolytic vertebral compression fractures due to multiple
myeloma found similar satisfying results [34]. Fifty-five consecutive kypho
plasty procedures were performed in over 27 sessions in 18 patients. The mean
age of patients was 63.5 years (4879), the mean duration of symptoms was 11
months, and the mean follow-up 7.4 months. The range of levels treated were
from T6 to L5 (T11 9, T12 7, L1 8, L2 7). There were no major com
plications related directly to the use of this technique. On average, 34% of height
lost at the time of fracture was restored. After stratifying for those where height
was not restored the remaining vertebral bodies showed an average of 56%
height restoration. Asymptomatic cement leakage occurred at 2/55 levels (4%).
Lieberman 246
dramroo
Significant improvement in SF-36 scores occurred for bodily pain: 23.2 to 55.4
(p 0.0008) and physical function: 21.3 to 50.6 (p 0.0010), vitality: 31.3 to
47.5 (p 0.010), and social functioning: 40.6 to 64.8 (p 0.014). The authors
concluded that the kyphoplasty technique was efficacious in the treatment of
osteolytic vertebral compression fractures due to multiple myeloma and associ
ated with early clinical improvement of pain and function as well as some
restoration of vertebral body height in these patients.
Conclusion
Lieberman 248
dramroo
a combination of pharmacologics and timely reinforcement of at risk osteo
porotic vertebrae is the ultimate goal aside from prevention of osteoporosis
itself. It is here that new osteoconductive synthetic composites will figure more
prominently as an emerging alternative to cement. Advances in minimally
invasive surgical techniques, imaging, and synthetic engineering are rapidly
changing the treatment protocols available for osteoporotic compression
fracture.
References
Tel. 1 216 445 2743, Fax 1 216 444 3328, E-Mail [email protected]
Lieberman 250
dramroo
Minimally Invasive Update
Endoscopic Posterior
Microdiscectomy
dramroo
a b
c d
Fig. 1. METRx instrumentation used for performing CMED with figures showing
K-wire, sequential dilators and tubular retractor (a), endoscopic assembly (b), long tapered
Drill (c), and specialized instruments (d).
Background
Perez-Cruet/Fessler 252
dramroo
complex as opposed to striping the muscle from the spinous process and lamina
and aggressively retracting the muscles laterally to gain access to the facet
complex. The instrumentations used to perform this technique were originally
designed for the treatment of lumbar disc herniation (fig. 1). The ability to
perform CMED was first determined in cadaveric studies [16]. These studies
determined that the METRx system could be used effectively to treat degenera
tive cervical disease and then was applied safely in a clinical setting [1, 11].
Evaluation
Indications
Perez-Cruet/Fessler 254
dramroo
250.0
400.0
350.0
Average blood loss
200.0
Operative time
300.0
250.0 150.0
200.0
150.0 100.0
100.0 50.0
50.0
0.0 0.0
a All Sitting Prone b All Sitting Prone
Fig. 3. Operative blood loss (a) and time (b) when performing the CMED procedure
in all patients combined, in the semisitting position, and in the prone position.
procedure and to rule out secondary gain or psychological issues that may result
in a poor surgical outcome.
Fig. 5. The position of the surgeon, while standing behind the patient, viewing the
endoscopic image on the operative monitor. Note the ergonomically favorable position of the
surgeons hands and body posture.
Perez-Cruet/Fessler 256
dramroo
Somatosensory evoked potentials, as well as EMG recordings, are measured to
further ensure the safety of the procedure. After the initial induction of anes
thesia, we have refrained from the use of neuromuscular paralytics to allow for
improved feedback from the nerve root(s) during the operation. A single
preoperative dose of either Ancef or vancomycin is used. We do not routinely
employ Solumedrol or other glucocorticoids for neural protection.
The fluoroscopic C-arm is brought into the surgical field and positioned
with the arc over the patient so that real-time lateral fluoroscopic images can
easily be obtained (fig. 6). Although we have not typically use anteroposterior
images, they can also be utilized to facilitate docking of the initial K-wire and
tubular retractors on the facet complex. The surgeon generally stands directly
behind the neck of the patient with the video and fluoroscopic monitors placed
within direct view of the surgeon to allow optimal ergonomic flow during the
procedure (fig. 5).
Surgical Technique
d e f
Fig. 6. Lateral fluoroscopic images showing docking of the K-wire on the facet com
plex (a), first dilator (b), second dilator after K-wire is removed (c), third dilator (d), fourth
dilator (e), and tubular retractor in place with curette-identifying facet (f).
Perez-Cruet/Fessler 258
dramroo
soft tissue dilators. It is important to remove the K-wire after the initial dilator
is passed. A series of dilators are then sequentially inserted using a gentle
downward rotating maneuver through the posterior neck musculature, over
which an 18-mm tubular retractor was inserted. Real-time lateral fluoroscopic
images were obtained throughout the above procedure to insure proper docking
of the sequential dilators and tubular retractors on the facet complex (fig. 6af).
The working channel (tubular retractor) is then attached to a flexible arm
affixed to the operating table side rail and locked in position. The retractor arm
is positioned to avoid obscuring the lateral fluoroscopic image. The endoscope
is then attached to the tubular retractor via a circular plastic friction couple.
Additionally, the endoscopic camera used today has far superior resolution and
clarity than the cameras used during our previous cadaveric studies and initial
operative cases. Further modifications of the instruments are ongoing to
improve the safety, efficacy, and ease of this procedure.
Once the tubular retractor is set in the desired position, a Bovey cautery
with a long insulated tip is used to remove the remaining muscle and soft tissue
overlying the facet complex. A small straight or up-going curette in conjunction
with lateral fluoroscopic imaging can further define the bone anatomy and local
ization of surgical anatomy (fig. 6f). The dissection is initially started laterally
where the bone is easily palpated with the Bovey tip. Once the bone of the lat
eral facet complex in exposed, the dissection of muscle off the facet complex
continues medial to expose the laminofacet junction with care not to enter the
interlaminar space with the Bovey tip. To prevent Bovey cautery smoke from
obscuring the endoscopic image during this procedure a frequent on/off tech
nique is used that allows smoke to clear from the tube before proceeding.
A suction tubing is also attached to the endoscopic device. If the tubular retractor
is properly placed initially only a small piece of muscle tissue needs be removed
to expose the facet complex. Often the ligamentum flavum is thinned or
altogether absent near the lateral edge of the interlaminar space thereby placing
the dura and spinal cord at higher risk. With the bone well visualized the inferior
edge of the superior lamina and the medial edge of the lateral mass-facet
complex are identified with a small straight or up-going endoscopic curette. The
facet complex at the proper level is clearly identified before proceeding.
Bleeding from epidural veins is controlled using a long tipped endoscopic
bipolar cautery. For bleeding underneath the edge of the lamina, angled bipolar
forceps with a 45 angle are often useful. After the medial facet plane has been
clearly defined, a small angled 1- or 2-mm Kerrison rongeur is used to begin the
foraminotomy (fig. 7a). Periosteal and bone bleeding is addressed with bone
wax and cautery. In cases of marked facet arthropathy and enlargement, a drill
with a long endoscopic bit (e.g. AM-8 bit with Midas Rex or TAC bit with
MEDNext drill) can be used to further thin the medial facet and lateral mass.
c d
Fig. 7. Intraoperative images showing Kerrison punch initiating medial facet removal
(a), nerve probe passing out of the foramen once foraminotomy is performed with underly
ing nerve root exposed (b), lateral fluoroscopic image with down-going curette on disc under
nerve root (c), and endoscopic image showing removal of disc fragment (d).
Frequent dissection of the soft tissue off the bone with an angled curette facili
tates safe use of the Kerrison rongeur. In this fashion, the decompression is care
fully continued inferiorly and laterally along the course of the neural foramen.
The laminoforaminotomy is completed when the nerve root had been well
exposed along its proximal foraminal course. The adequacy of the decompres
sion should be confirmed by palpating the root along its course with a small
nerve hook (fig. 7b).
In cases where a herniated cervical disk or free disc fragment is present,
additional exposure is obtained by drilling a small portion of the superomedial
Perez-Cruet/Fessler 260
dramroo
pedicle directly below the exiting nerve root. As the nerve root lies directly
against this portion of the pedicle, removing a small portion of the pedicle will
create enough space for passing a down-going curette (fig. 7c) under the nerve
root to remove a disc fragment without traumatizing the nerve root (fig. 7d).
Additionally osteophytes encountered in this region can also be drilled or curet
ted as needed. Prior to closure the nerve root is palpated along its anterior
surface to ensure that no residual compression exists along its course.
Far lateral foraminal stenosis or disc herniations can also be decompressed
through this approach. As the nerve root often passes in close proximity to the
vertebral artery laterally, particular attention should be paid during decompres
sion in this area. Inadvertent passage of instruments beyond the bone defining
the posterior margin of the foramen transversarium should be avoided. Brisk
dark bleeding is often encountered from the rich venous plexus, which typically
surrounds the space around the vertebral artery. When encountered, such bleed
ing should serve as a useful warning to limit further dissection and thus prevent
inadvertent arterial injury. Unnecessary excessive decompression of the facet
should be avoided to prevent iatrogenic instability of the cervical motion
segment. Raynor et al. [15] concluded that the integrity of the majority of the
facet joint is essential for stability and that no more than 50% of the facet
should be removed to maintain its integrity.
Wound Closure
Postoperative Care
The patient was then awakened from anesthesia and taken to the postanes
thesia recovery unit. Most patients have the procedure on an ambulatory basis;
therefore, long-acting inhalational and intravenous agents should be avoided to
allow for rapid awakening of the patient postoperatively. Additionally, use of
only short-acting muscle relaxants for initial induction will allow for better
monitoring of nerve root function as well as quicker extubation of the patient
after surgery. This procedure performed on an outpatient basis requires
thorough perioperative patient education [14].
Once in the postanesthesia recovery area, the patients are allowed to
rapidly mobilize and ambulate as tolerated. Arterial and intravenous lines are
removed early on. If a Foley catheter was placed it is generally removed before
the patient leaves the operative suite. Done correctly, this procedure does not
result in either instability or fusion of the operated cervical motion segment.
Therefore no cervical collar is required. Soft collars and other comfortable
semirigid collars can be given to patients for their comfort if desired. It is
important to emphasize to patients, however, that chronic dependence on such
orthosis will only lead to further deconditioning of the cervical musculature.
Depending on their preoperative medications, patients are typically discharged
on a combination of muscle relaxants (e.g. baclofen or Flexeril), nonsteroidal
anti-inflammatories (e.g. Toradol, Vioxx, or Celebrex), and an oral opioid for
breakthrough pain (i.e. Vicodin or Darvocet). When we compared our patients
with patients treated via open cervical foraminotomy, we found that the
microendoscopic foraminotomy (MEF) group used significantly less pain med
ications postoperatively than did the open group [11]. Patients undergoing this
procedure typically recovered rapidly with only mild to moderate discomfort
upon discharge. Of our last 30 cases, the majority of patients were discharged
in 6 h or less.
Complication Avoidance
Perez-Cruet/Fessler 262
dramroo
(MEF) and reported complications in 3 patients; 2 cases of dural puncture
required no intervention other than gel-foam and 1 case of superficial wound
infection was reported. In a series by Khoo et al. [11] three complications
occurred in 25 patients and were attributable to surgical technique. These
included two small cerebral spinal fluid (CSF) leaks and 1 case of partial-
thickness dural violation. For the 2 cases where a CSF leak occurred, no direct
repair was required as the durotomy was very small. After 23 days of routine
lumbar drainage for patients with CSF leaks, none of these patients went on
to have long-term clinical sequelae of chronic CSF leak or symptomatic
pseudomeningocele. Thus we have routinely employed a lumbar drain for 23
days postoperatively to help closure of the small dural tear. Additional adjuncts
such as fibrin glue, fat or muscle grafts can also be used. Spinal headaches and
nausea associated with the lumbar drainage were treated symptomatically with
nonsteroidal anti-inflammatory medications and bed rest. If a large durotomy
occurs, direct dural repair can be attempted if specialized instruments are avail
able for use through the endoscopic tube. Castro-Viejo-type needle holders and
long forceps are particularly useful in this regard. In rare instances, conversion
to an open procedure may be necessary to close large dural violations. To date,
we have not had problems with delayed pseudomeningoceles or continued CSF
leaks. The risk of dural injury can be reduced with experience in performing
this technique with most durotomies occurring on initial patients undergoing
this procedure. Patients should be advised of this potential complication and
informed that with appropriate management durotomy results in no adverse
clinical result.
A potential complication, which has not been reported, is iatrogenic injury
during the surgical approach and muscle dilatation portion of this operation.
Unlike the thoracodorsal fascia, the posterior cervical fascia is very thick and
must be cut under direct visualization to prevent hyperextension of the neck
during insertion of the dilators. The initial K-wire or smaller dilators can be
inadvertently pushed between the cervical lamina resulting in nerve root or
spinal cord injury; therefore, this portion of the procedure is performed under
lateral fluoroscopic guidance. An anteroposterior fluoroscopic image can also
help in safely docking the K-wire and subsequent dilators on the facet complex.
Additionally, lateral displacement of the K-wire or dilators can result in nerve
root or vertebral artery injury. Brisk venous bleeding can also result if the
dilators inadvertently slip lateral to the facet complex during placement. This is
controlled with gentle gel-foam packing and/or bipolar cautery. The K-wire is
removed after the first dilator is passed and subsequent dilators securely docked
onto the laminar facet junction.
To help reduce intraoperative bleeding the CMED procedure is performed
in the semisitting position (fig. 4). A series of patients comparing cervical
Conclusion
References
Perez-Cruet/Fessler 264
dramroo
10 Hunter LY, Braunstein EM, Bailey RR: Radiographic changes following anterior cervical fusion.
Spine 1980;5:399401.
11 Khoo LT, Perez-Cruet MJ, Laich DT, Fessler RG: Posterior cervical microendoscopic foramino
tomy; in Perez-Cruet MJ, Fessler RG (eds): Outpatient Spinal Surgery. St. Louis, Quality Medical
Publishing, 2002, pp 7193.
12 Krupp W, Muke R: Clinical results of the foraminotomy as described by Fryholm for the treatment
of lateral cervical disc herniation. Acta Neurochir (Wien) 1990;107:2229.
13 Perez-Cruet MJ, Smith M, Foley K: Microendoscopic lumbar discectomy; in Perez-Cruet MJ,
Fessler RG (eds): Outpatient Spinal Surgery. St. Louis, Quality Medical Publishing, 2002,
pp 171183.
14 Perez-Cruet MJ, Rice-Wyllie L, Pieper DR: Patient education; in Perez-Cruet MJ, Fessler RG
(eds): Outpatient Spinal Surgery. St. Louis, Quality Medical Publishing, 2002, pp 3547.
15 Raynor RB, Pugh J, Shapiro I: Cervical facetectomy and its effect of spine strength. J Neurosurg
1985;63:278282.
16 Roh SW, Kim DH, Cardoso AC, Fessler RG: Endoscopic foraminotomy using microendoscopic
discectomy system in cadaveric specimens. Spine 2000;25:260264.
17 Simeone F, Dillin W: Treatment of cervical disc disease: Selection of operative approach.
Contemp Neurosurg 1986;8:16.
18 Tomaras CR, Blacklock JB, Parker WD, Harper RL: Outpatient surgical treatment of cervical
radiculopathy. J Neurosurg 1997;87:4143.
19 Williams RW: Microcervical foraminotomy. A surgical alternative for intractable radicular pain.
Spine 1983;8:708716.
Tel. 1 708 250 3194, Fax 1 312 942 2176, E-Mail [email protected]
dramroo
Perot and Munro [33] and Ransohoff et al. [34] performed the initial
transthoracic approach to thoracic disc herniation after which the transthoracic
approach became a standard procedure to manage thoracic disc herniations. This
approach provides excellent visualization of the ventral aspect of the thoracic
spine without the risk of spinal cord manipulation. However, the thoracotomy
used in this approach requires a large skin incision, extensive lung and rib retrac
tion, and muscle dissection, all of which can contribute to postoperative
pulmonary dysfunction, pain and increased morbidity.
To reduce the morbidity associated with the thoracotomy technique and
other approaches previously mentioned, less invasive thoracoscopic techniques
have been developed and more recently refined for the treatment of herniated
thoracic disc [1, 8, 9, 35, 36]. Thoracoscopy is capable of producing the same
exposure as the transthoracic route without the need for a large thoracotomy
incision. Thoracoscopy was introduced by Jacobeus in 1910 [19]. However, this
technique was not widely adopted at that time due to poor illumination of
intrathoracic structures and other technical limitations. It was not until the
1970s that the modern era of surgical endoscopy began following a number of
technical advancements such as fiberoptics, and the operating endoscopes.
Introduction of the video camera into thoracoscopic surgery was the next major
advance leading to the introduction of the video-assisted thoracoscopic surgery
technique [14, 18, 19, 35]. Thoracoscopic discectomy is an effective alternative
to traditional open thoracotomy techniques that has been found to reduce the
incidence of pulmonary morbidity [11, 13], intercostal neuralgia, and shoulder
girdle dysfunction [13, 20]. Although the incidence thoracoscopic complica
tions may vary they are similar to those encountered with open thoracotomy
[16, 30].
Although the procedure-associated morbidity is much less than with
thoracotomy, the prevalence of pulmonary complications such as postoperative
atelectasis, pneumothorax, pleural effusion, and hemothorax is considerable
[7, 10, 22, 37, 39]. In addition, thoracoscopic surgery is technically demanding
and requires attainment of new surgical skills. Therefore, it is advised that
surgeons perform the thoracoscopic procedures only after pursuing appropriate
training that includes extensive practice of this skill in a surgical laboratory [4].
Even today the use of video-assisted thoracoscopic surgery techniques to treat
thoracic disc herniation have not been widely adopted due to the steep learning
curve which requires specialized training to master.
The primary indication for thoracoscopic spinal surgery is management of
herniated discs that compress the spinal cord and/or nerve root. Severe or
progressive myelopathy from spinal cord compression caused by disc herniation
is an absolute indication for surgery [19, 27]. In addition to thoracic discectomy,
current indications for thoracoscopic spine surgery include tissue biopsies,
Indication
Perez-Cruet/Kim/Sandhu/Fessler 268
dramroo
modification, and hyperextension brace [41]. Pain relief after thoracic discec
tomy is usually favorable in patients with radiculopathy, even for those with
long-standing radiculopathy. Although it is controversial whether patients with
localized back pain and axial pain without myelopathy require surgery or not,
most surgeons do not recommend thoracic discectomy for isolated back pain
unless it is associated with a neurological deficit [28, 29, 37, 38, 40]. This tech
nique is not recommended for a large calcified midline thoracic disc that may
require an anterior approach.
Technique
Perez-Cruet/Kim/Sandhu/Fessler 270
dramroo
a b
c d
e f
Fig. 1. a Positioning of the patient in the prone position on a radiolucent frame with
lateral fluoroscopy for performing TMED procedure. After placing a K wire on the trans
verse process (b, c) a series of muscle dilators are used over which a tubular retractor is
placed (d). e The operation is then performed under endoscopic visualization. f A Woodson
elevator instrument is useful in removing a central disc herniation.
a b
10
c d
T9, 10
T9, 10
e f
Fig. 2. Pre (a, c, e)- and respective post (b, d, f )-operative images showing decom
pression of the spinal cord following a three-level (T6, 7; T8, 9, and T9, 10) TMED.
Perez-Cruet/Kim/Sandhu/Fessler 272
dramroo
Fig. 3. Postoperative scar after three-level TMED procedure. Of note, no fusion was
required nor entry into the thoracic cavity for performing a multilevel thoracic discectomy.
posterior muscle dissection. As a result, patient stays are brief with the major
ity of patients being discharge the following morning.
Illustrative Case
A 45-year-old female presented with polyradiculopathy and myelopathy
from three thoracic disc herniations one at T6, 7, another at T8, 9 and another
at T9, 10. The patient underwent a right-sided T6, 7 TMED and a left-sided T8, 9
and T9, 10 TMED. Pre- and postoperative sagittal and axial MRI images show
the extent of disc removal (fig. 2cf) with final decompression of the spinal
cord. The patient went on to make a full recovery with minimal postoperative
wound scar (fig. 3) and returned to work. In a series of 5 patients treated in this
manner, aged 2354 years, operative times averaged 1.8 h per level and blood
loss was approximately 113 ml per level. No cases required conversion to an
open procedure and all patients showed improvement in functional outcome as
measured by visual pain analog, Oswestry scores, and SF-36.
Discussion
References
1 Anand N, Regan JJ: Video-assisted thoracoscopic surgery for thoracic disc disease: Classification
and outcome study of 100 consecutive cases with a 2-year minimum follow-up period. Spine
2002;27:871879.
2 Arlet V: Anterior thoracoscopic spine release in deformity surgery: A meta-analysis and review.
Eur Spine J 2000;9(suppl 1):S17S23.
3 Awwad EE, Martin DS, et al: Asymptomatic versus symptomatic herniated thoracic disc: Their
frequency and characteristics as detected by computed tomography after myelography.
Neurosurgery 1991;28:180186.
4 Birch BD, Desai RD, et al: Surgical approaches to the thoracolumbar spine. Neurosurg Clin N Am
1997;8:471485.
5 Burgos J, Rapariz JM, et al: Anterior endoscopic approach to the thoracolumbar spine. Spine
1998;23:24272431.
6 Cunningham BW, Kotani Y, et al: Video-assisted thoracoscopic surgery versus open thoracotomy
for anterior thoracic spinal fusion. A comparative radiographic, biomechanical, and histologic
analysis in a sheep model. Spine 1998;23:13331340.
7 Dickman CA, Mican CA: Multilevel anterior thoracic discectomies and anterior interbody fusion
using a microsurgical thoracoscopic approach. J Neurosurg 1996;84:104109.
8 Dickman CA, Rosenthal D, et al: Thoracic vertebrectomy and reconstruction using a microsurgi
cal thoracoscopic approach. Neurosurgery 1996;38:279293.
9 Dickman CA, Rosenthal D, et al: Reoperation for herniated thoracic discs. J Neurosurg
1999;91(suppl 2):157162.
10 Faciszewski T, Winter RB, et al: The surgical and medical perioperative complications of anterior
spinal fusion surgery in the thoracic and lumbar spine in adults. Spine 1995;20:15921599.
11 Ferson PF, Landreneau RJ, Dowling RD, Hazelrigg SR, Ritter P, Nunchuck S, Perrino MK,
Bowers CM, Mack MJ, Magee MJ: Comparison of open versus thoracoscopic lung biopsy for
diffuse infiltrative pulmonary disease. J Thorac Cardiovasc Surg 1993;106:194199.
Perez-Cruet/Kim/Sandhu/Fessler 274
dramroo
12 Fessler RG, Sturgill M: Review: Complications of surgery for thoracic disc disease. Surg Neurol
1998;49:609618.
13 Hazelrigg SR, Landreneau RJ, Boley TM, Priesmeyer M, Schmaltz RA, Nawarawong W,
Johnson JA, Walls JT, Curtis JJ: The effect of muscle-sparing versus standard posterolateral tho
racotomy on pulmonary function, muscle strength, and postoperative pain. J Thorac Cardiovasc
Surg 1991;101:394401.
14 Horowirz BH, Moossy JJ, et al: Thoracic discectomy using video assisted thoracoscopy. Spine
1994;19:10821086.
15 Huang TJ, Hsu RW, et al: Video-assisted thoracoscopic treatment of spinal lesions in the thora
columbar junction. Surg Endosc 1997;11:11891193.
16 Huang TJ, Hsu RW, et al: Complications in thoracoscopic spinal surgery: A study of 90 consecu
tive patients. Surg Endosc 1999;13:346350.
17 Huntington CF, Murrell WD, et al: Comparison of thoracoscopic and open thoracic discectomy in
a live ovine model for anterior spinal fusion. Spine 1998;23:16991702.
18 Karahalios DG, Apostolides PJ, et al: Thoracoscopic spinal surgery. Treatment of thoracic insta
bility. Neurosurg Clin N Am 1997;8:555573.
19 Kuklo TR, Lenke LG: Thoracoscopic spine surgery: Current indications and techniques. Orthop
Nurs 2000;19/6:1522.
20 Landreneau RJ, Hazelrigg SR, Mack MJ, Dowling RD, Burke D, Gavlick J, Perrino MK, Ritter PS,
Bowers CM, DeFino J: Postoperative pain-related morbidity: Video-assisted thoracic surgery
versus thoracotomy. Ann Thorac Surg 1993;56:12851289.
21 Larson SJ, Holst RA, Hemmy DC, Sances A: Lateral extracavitary approach to traumatic lesions
of the thoracic and lumbar spine. J Neurosurg 1976;45:628637.
22 McAfee PC, Regan JR, et al: The incidence of complication in endoscopic anterior thoracolum
bar spinal reconstructive surgery. Spine 1995;20:16241632.
23 Newton PO, Shea KG, et al: Defining the pediatric spinal thoracoscopy learning curve: Sixty-five
consecutive cases. Spine 2000;25:10281035.
24 Newton PO, Wenger DR, et al: Anterior release and fusion in pediatric spinal deformity. A com
parison of early outcome and cost of thoracoscopic and open thoracotomy approaches. Spine
1997;22:13981406.
25 Niemeyer T, Freeman BJ, et al: Anterior thoracoscopic surgery followed by posterior instrumen
tation and fusion in spinal deformity. Eur Spine J 2000;9:499504.
26 Nymberg SM, Crawford AH: Video-assisted thoracoscopic releases of scoliotic anterior spines.
AORN J 1996;63:561562, 565569, 571575; quiz 576, pass.
27 Oskouian RJ Jr, Johnson JP, et al: Thoracoscopic microdiscectomy. Neurosurgery 2002;50/1:
103109.
28 Otani K, Yoshida M, et al: Thoracic disc herniation. Surgical treatment in 23 patients. Spine
1988;13:12621267.
29 Peker S, Akkurt C, et al: Multiple thoracic disc herniations. Acta Neurochir (Wien) 1990;
107/34:167170.
30 Perez-Cruet MJ, Fessler RG, Noel PI: Review: Complications of minimally invasive spinal
surgery. Neurosurgery 2002;51(suppl 2):2636.
31 Perez-Cruet MJ, Foley KT, Isaacs RE, Rice-Wyllie L, Wellington R, Smith MM, Fessler RG:
Microendoscopic lumbar discectomy: Technical note. Neurosurgery 2002;51(suppl 2):129136.
32 Perez-Cruet MJ, Smith MM, Foley KT: Microendoscopic lumbar discectomy; in Perez-Cruet MJ,
Fessler RG (eds): Outpatient Spinal Surgery. St Louis, Quality Medical Publishing, 2002,
pp 171183.
33 Perot PL, Munro DD: Transthoracic removal of midline thoracic disc protrusions causing spinal
cord compression. J Neurosurg 1969;31:458.
34 Ransohoff J, Spencer F, et al: Transthoracic removal of thoracic discs: Case reports and technical
notes. J Neurosurg 1969;31:459461.
35 Regan JJ: Percutaneous endoscopic thoracic discectomy. Neurosurg Clin N Am 1996;7/1:8798.
36 Regan JJ, Guyer RD: Endoscopic techniques in spinal surgery. Clin Orthop 1997;335:122139.
37 Rosenthal D, Dickman CA: Thoracoscopic microsurgical excision of herniated thoracic discs.
J Neurosurg 1998;89/2:224235.
Tel. 1 708 250 3194, Fax 1 312 942 2176, E-Mail [email protected]
Perez-Cruet/Kim/Sandhu/Fessler 276
dramroo
Haid RW Jr, Subach BR, Rodts GE Jr (eds): Advances in Spinal Stabilization.
The anterior approach for a lumbar interbody fusion was originally designed
to treat Potts disease [1]. Since that time, the anterior lumbar interbody fusion
(ALIF) has evolved into an effective and popular alternative in the treatment of
a variety of lumbar degenerative disorders, including degenerative disc disease,
low-grade spondylolisthesis, and posterior pseudoarthrosis. Compared to tradi
tional posterior fusion techniques, the ALIF operation is associated with shorter
operative times, decreased blood loss, less postoperative pain, reduced hospital
stay, and shorter recovery periods [25].
Supporters of the ALIF argue that reconstruction of the anterior column is
biomechanically superior, avoids paraspinal muscle trauma and denervation,
indirectly decompresses the intervertebral foramen, improves sagittal balance,
and allows a more efficient restoration of disc interspace height compared to
posterior fusion techniques [68]. The anterior position of the interbody graft
increases the likelihood of fusion by exposing the graft to fusion-promoting
forces in accordance with Wolffs law [9]. The interbody space also provides an
increased surface area for fusion formation and robust blood supply following
decortication of the vertebral endplates [10].
Early in the development of the ALIF technique, open approaches, such as
the transperitoneal or retroperitoneal approach, were utilized to expose the ante
rior lumbar spine. Although providing adequate visualization, these more exten
sive exposures were associated with increased postoperative morbidity. As the
ALIF technique evolved, emphasis was placed on exposing the spine through
less invasive approaches. These minimally invasive techniques are intended to
decrease postoperative morbidity, reduce hospitalization time, and shorten the
dramroo
recovery period with comparable or superior treatment outcomes compared to
more traditional techniques.
Laparoscopic ALIF
Todays spine surgeon has two such options for approaching an ALIF: the
laparoscopic approach and the mini-open laparotomy. Zucherman et al. [11]
were the first to report the use of the laparoscopic approach for an anterior
interbody fusion. This technique is considered by many as the least invasive
approach to the ventral lumbar spine and in many centers has become the stan
dard technique when performing an ALIF, particularly at the L5/S1 disc inter
space. The safety and efficacy of an anterior laparoscopic fusion have been
reported in numerous reports [2, 3, 1216].
The small incisions required for insertion of the laparoscopic working
channels reduce the extent of abdominal wall muscle dissection and blood loss,
both contributing to a decrease in postoperative pain. The laparoscopic
approach is also associated with less direct manipulation of the abdominal con
tents, resulting in a decreased incidence of postoperative ileus. These charac
teristics are thought to reduce postoperative morbidity and contribute to a
shorter length of hospitalization.
Mini-Open ALIF
Kaiser/Haid/Subach/Rodts 278
dramroo
significant advantage over the mini-open approach when performing an ALIF
at the L4/5 interspace [5].
The mini-open approach provides direct access to the disc interspace
and allows easier identification of the anatomical midline. The open technique
allows complete disc removal, resection of any herniated fragments, and
increased endplate exposure, improving the preparation of the disc interspace
for fusion formation compared to the trephine technique used with the laparo
scopic approach. The mini-open laparotomy is less technically demanding,
contributing to a shorter preparation and operative time. The reduced inci
dence of retrograde ejaculation has also been observed with the mini-open
laparotomy [4].
Surgical Technique
Patient Positioning
There are a number of previously published reports describing the details
of both the laparoscopic and mini-open techniques [3, 6, 14, 18]. For both
approaches the assistance of either a general or vascular surgeon, familiar with
laparoscopic techniques when indicated, is advised. This team approach will
optimize the speed and safety of the procedure, providing the patient with
maximal benefit.
Patient positioning is essentially identical for each approach, however
accommodations for the video monitor are required with the laparoscopic
exposure. The patient is positioned supine on a radiolucent operative table
with a pillow or bolster placed under the patients hips to accentuate the
natural lumbar lordosis and under the knees to avoid hyperextension. The
patient is securely strapped to the operative table. This is particularly neces
sary for the laparoscopic approach due to the steep Trendelenburg position
required to allow the abdominal viscera to move rostrally out of the pelvis.
Fluoroscopic imaging is used with both techniques during positioning of the
implants.
Laparoscopic Technique
The patient is prepared and draped under sterile conditions in the usual
fashion. The fluoroscopic equipment is brought into the operative field to con
firm the midline prior to any incisions. For the laparoscopic approach, intra-
abdominal access is obtained through four small incisions in the anterior
abdominal wall (fig. 1). The viewing camera is inserted through a curvilinear
umbilical incision and two lower paramedian incisions provide portals for the
5- or 10-mm
5- or 10-mm trocar
trocar
L4/L5 or
18-mm trocar L5/S1
(working port)
suprapubic
Fig. 1. Diagram demonstrating the trocar placement for laparoscopic ALIF. The chan
nels for working instruments are provided through two paramedian incisions. The laparo
scope is inserted through an umbilical incision and the instrumentation portal through a
suprapubic incision.
Kaiser/Haid/Subach/Rodts 280
dramroo
Fig. 2. Final placement of abdominal
trocars following insufflation of the
abdomen. The instrumentation trocar is
positioned toward the top and the laparo
scope toward the bottom of the photograph.
3 4
Fig. 3. Anterior view of the lumbosacral spine prior to retroperitoneal exposure. The
dotted line indicates a possible peritoneal incision to access the retroperitoneum and anterior
disc space.
Fig. 4. Lateral view of the instrumentation port positioned within the disc interspace
for trephination of the disc material and insertion of implant.
technique according to the guidelines specific for the implant chosen (fig. 4).
Following radiographic confirmation of implant position, the posterior
peritoneum is closed using clip ligation. The abdominal incisions are closed
with interrupted absorbable sutures and Steri-Strips.
Mini-Open Technique
Excluding the equipment required for a laparoscopic approach, the opera
tive setup is identical. The level of incision is determined with fluoroscopic
imaging, with a bias toward the caudal border of the level of arthrodesis. This
bias will provide a more tangent approach into the disc space and avoid exces
sive reaming into the inferior vertebral body. A longitudinal or transverse
incision approximately 46 cm in length is made in the suprapubic region.
A longitudinal incision is reserved for two-level ALIF procedures or for obese
patients (fig. 5). After the skin incision is made, monopolar cautery is used to
dissect down to the rectus abdominus muscle that is split in a longitudinal fash
ion parallel to the muscle fiber plane. The posterior rectus sheath and transver
salis fascia are divided to expose the underlying peritoneum. The peritoneum is
incised and the abdominal contents packed superiorly held in position with a
table-mounted retractor (fig. 6). Although the anterior lumbar spine can be
approached through either a transperitoneal or retroperitoneal exposure, our
preference has been the transperitoneal route since a more direct anterior
trajectory is obtained.
The posterior peritoneum overlying the disc interspace is identified and
sharply divided. Exposure of the L5/S1 interspace is usually easier due to the
more rostral bifurcation of the great vessels. In order to expose L4/5 interspace
the left iliac artery and vein are mobilized. It is imperative that the iliolumbar vein
be identified and ligated. Transection of this vein without adequate control can
Kaiser/Haid/Subach/Rodts 282
dramroo
Fig. 6. A table-mounted retractor system is placed to optimize exposure and retract the
abdominal contents rostrally.
Fig. 7. Once the retractor blades are positioned and the posterior peritoneum opened
the anterior surface of the disc is easily identified.
Fig. 9. Intraoperative view of the double-barrel channel in position for implant insertion.
A complete removal of the disc is performed and the entire endplate prepared
for graft insertion (fig. 8). The interbody implant is then inserted according to
manufacturers guidelines along with additional autologous bone (fig. 9). Once the
appropriate implant position is verified with intraoperative fluoroscopic images,
the posterior peritoneum is primarily closed with a running absorbable suture.
The anterior peritoneum, transversalis fascia, and rectus sheath are closed with
interrupted absorbable sutures and the skin closed with staples.
Kaiser/Haid/Subach/Rodts 284
dramroo
Postoperative Care
The postoperative course for both the laparoscopic and mini-open groups
is essentially identical. Mobilization occurs early, typically on the first postop
erative day, and their diet advanced with the initiation of bowel sounds. Patients
are generally discharged once they are able to tolerate an oral diet, able to
ambulate, and voiding without difficulty. Occasionally this may be as early as
the 2nd day following surgery. Radiographic images, to determine implant
position, are obtained prior to discharge and during scheduled follow-up visits,
at approximately 6 weeks, 3, 6, 9, 12 and 24 months postoperatively.
There have been few studies that directly compared the mini-open laparot
omy to the laparoscopic ALIF. Regan et al. [19] compared their experience of 65
laparoscopic fusions to a large number of both anterior and posterior open
interbody fusions. The mean operative time was significantly shorter for the mini-
open ALIF compared to the laparoscopic approach, 149 compared to 207 min.
The average blood loss during the mini-open procedure was 224 ml (range
202,000 ml) and for the laparoscopic approach 176 ml (range 102,200 ml). The
trend for decreased blood loss with the laparoscopic approach did not prove sta
tistically significant. The mean length of hospitalization was essentially the same
for both groups, approximately 3.9 days for the laparoscopic group and 4.0 days
following the mini-open approach. There were several technical complications
associated with the laparoscopic approach that occurred early in the surgeons
operative experience. Nine attempts at a laparoscopic fusion were aborted and
converted to an open approach, 3 secondary to laceration of the iliac vein.
In 2 cases a herniated disc was noted to impinge upon a nerve root requiring a
second operation for removal of the herniated fragment.
More recently Zdeblick and David [5] presented their experience with both
the mini-open and laparoscopic approaches. Over a 3-year period data was
prospectively collected on 50 patients who underwent an ALIF involving the
L4/5 disc interspace, with an equal number of laparoscopic and mini-open
laparotomy procedures. The authors found no statistical difference in operating
time, intraoperative blood loss, or length of hospital stay between the two
groups. When two-level procedures were considered separately, a significant
increase in the mean operative time was noted with the laparoscopic approach,
185 versus 160 min. The laparoscopic group demonstrated a significantly
higher complication rate, 20 versus 4%. Based on these observations, the
authors concluded that the laparoscopic approach offered no advantage over the
mini-open laparotomy when performing an ALIF involving the L4/5 level.
Laparoscopic Mini-open
Laparoscopic Mini-open
Kaiser/Haid/Subach/Rodts 286
dramroo
Table 3. Intraoperative complications Table 4. Postoperative complications
Laparoscopic Laparoscopic
Bladder perforation UTI
Iliac vein laceration New onset radiculopathy
Conversion to open procedure (n 2) Mini-open
Mini-open Transient ileus (n 5)
Iliac vein laceration (n 2) Retroperitoneal hematoma
UTI
Wound infection
Worsened radiculopathy
Conclusions
References
1 Ito H, Tsuchiya J, Asami G: A new radical operation for Potts disease. J Bone Joint Surg Br
1934;16:499515.
2 Dickman C, Sonntag V, Russell J: The laparoscopic approach for instrumentation and fusion of the
lumbar spine. BNI Q 1997;13:2636.
3 McLaughlin M, Zhang J, Subach B, Haid R, Rodts G: Laparoscopic anterior lumbar interbody
fusion: Technical note. Neurosurg Focus 1999;7:16.
Kaiser/Haid/Subach/Rodts 288
dramroo
4 Reagan J, Yuan H, McAfee P: Laparoscopic fusion of the lumbar spine: Minimally invasive spine
surgery. A prospective multicenter study evaluating open and laparoscopic lumbar fusion. Spine
1999;24:402411.
5 Zdeblick T, David S: A prospective comparison of surgical approach for anterior L4L5 fusion:
Laparoscopic versus mini anterior lumbar interbody fusion. Spine 2000;25:26822687.
6 McLaughlin M, Haid R, Rodts G, Miller J: Current role of anterior lumbar interbody fusion in
lumbar spine disorders. Semin Neurosurg 2000;11:221229.
7 Voor MJ, Mehta S, Wang M, Zhang YM, Mahan J, Johnson JR: Biomechanical evaluation of
posterior and anterior lumbar interbody fusion techniques. J Spinal Disord 1998;11:328334.
8 Greenough CG, Peterson MD, Hadlow S, Fraser RD: Instrumented posterolateral lumbar fusion.
Tel. 1 404 778 5770, Fax 1 404 778 4472, E-Mail [email protected]
Spine disease, with associated neck, back, and radicular pain, is common
and costly. In the current American health care environment, many types of
practitioners (primary care physicians, spine surgeons, physical therapists,
chiropractors, and others) are involved in managing patients with spine disease,
often with very different approaches. The varied nature and economic costs of
spine disease are driving a growing interest in research. The coming years may
reveal the fundamental aspects of this problem, as well as standardized treat
ment regimens, in more detail.
Burke/Gerszten 292
dramroo
Table 1. Incidence of several neurosurgical disease states
LBP 30,000
Carpal tunnel syndrome 2,800
Traumatic brain injury 150
Occlusive cerebral vascular disease 96
Intracerebral/intracranial hemorrhage 30
Malignant neoplasm of the brain 12
Subarachnoid hemorrhage (nontraumatic) 8
Traumatic spinal cord injury 4
injury is most common in young adult men. It is estimated that 63% of new
traumatic injuries occur in individuals between the ages of 16 and 30 years,
with a 4:1 male:female ratio [19].
Epidemiology of LBP
Burke/Gerszten 294
dramroo
while medical advances in spine treatment with diagnostic imaging and new
forms of surgical and nonsurgical therapy have developed. At the same time,
however, work disability caused by back pain has steadily risen! The positive
aspect is that most back pain patients will substantially and rapidly recover,
even when their pain is severe. This prognosis holds true regardless of treatment
method or even without treatment. Only a minority of patients with back pain
will miss work because of it. Most patients who do leave work return within
6 weeks, and only a small percentage never return to their jobs.
Patients with neck and back pain seek care from general practitioners,
chiropractors, orthopedists, neurosurgeons, rheumatologists, and others. There
is a wide variation in how doctors care for patients with neck and back pain,
with evidence of excessive imaging and surgery for the problem. In most cases
of LBP, patients recover within a few weeks of the onset of symptoms. The fact
that LBP often resolves spontaneously may partially explain the proliferation of
unproven treatments that may seem to be effective. When patient descriptions
are standardized, physician recommendations for neck and back pain evalua
tions vary enormously. Rheumatologists are twice as likely to order blood work
to rule-out arthritic conditions. Neurosurgeons are twice as likely to order
imaging studies. Neurologists are 3 times more likely to order EMGs [28].
Surgical procedures for herniated discs and spinal stenosis accounted for
83% of the more than 188,000 spine surgeries done in Medicare patients in
19961997. There were approximately 39,000 discectomies, 90,000 lumbar
decompressions, and 27,000 cervical spine procedures. The remaining 32,000
procedures were for other spinal conditions. Overall, spine surgery rates
increased by 57% over the 10-year period from 1988 to 1996, from 2.1 to 3.4 per
1,000 Medicare enrollees (fig. 1) [31].
There remains significant variation within the United States in the use of
surgery for many spine-related problems. Rates of spine surgery vary more than
any other common inpatient procedure. In 19961997, rates of spine surgery
varied by a factor of 6, from 1.4 per 1,000 Medicare enrollees in the Bronx,
N.Y. hospital referral region to 8.6 per 1,000 Medicare residents in Bend, Oreg.
Cervical spine procedures accounted for 14% of the spine surgery performed in
the Medicare population in 19961997; rates of cervical spine surgery varied
by a factor of more than 10, ranging from 0.16 to 1.72 per 1,000 Medicare
enrollees in the different hospital referral regions [31].
The use of spinal fusion displays a wide variation among geographic
areas, as well as varying from 0.3 to 3.0 per 1,000 Medicare enrollees (fig. 2).
3.0
2.5
2.0
1.5
1.0
0.5
0.0
1988 1989 1990 1991 1992 1993 1994 1995 1996 1997
Year
3.2
2.7
Spinal fusion procedures per
1,000 Medicare enrollees
2.2
1.7
1.2
0.7
0.2
Fig. 2. Rates of spinal fusion varied by a factor of almost 10, from 0.3 to 3.0 per 1,000
Medicare enrollees, after adjustment for differences in population age, sex and race
(19961997). Each point represents 1 of 306 hospital referral regions in the United States
[from 31, p. 38].
The proportion of patients undergoing spine surgery who received a spinal fusion
increased from 23% in 1993 to 29% in 1997. During the same period, the
proportion of patients undergoing fusion who received hardware fixation devices
rose from 50 to 60%. Among Medicare patients undergoing laminectomy for
Burke/Gerszten 296
dramroo
Percent of decompression
procedures for lumbar
stenosis that included fusion
by hospital referral region (19961997)
40 or more (12)
30 to 40 (45)
20 to 30 (114)
10 to 20 (97)
Not populated
Fig. 3. Use of fusion with surgery for lumbar spinal stenosis (19961997). Fusion was
used in at least 40% of lumbar decompression procedures in 12 hospital referral regions.
In 10 regions, fusion was used in less than 10% of operations [from 31, p. 41].
lumbar spinal stenosis, the use of fusion varied from 4% of the operations to 56%.
Figure 3 shows the variation across the United States in the use of fusion with
surgery for lumbar spinal stenosis [31].
It is unlikely that the large degree of regional variation in the use of spine
surgery reflects regional differences in the incidence of disease. Instead,
regional variation in surgery reflects differences in physician practice style
physicians in some regions of the United States are simply more inclined to rec
ommend surgery in patients with surgically treatable conditions of the spine.
The likelihood that patients will undergo particular surgical procedures of the
spine is remarkably variable. This is apparent on a local level, as well as with
surgical signatures reflecting the practice patterns of individual physicians
and the local medical culture. Neighboring regions with similar demographics
1.41
1.39
1.27
1.4
1.18
1.16
Ratio to US average (1996-1997)
1.09
1.08
1.2
1.04
0.98
0.98
0.94
0.93
0.92
0.88
1.0
0.86
0.84
0.83
0.72
0.72
0.8
0.62
0.61
0.53
0.51
0.6
0.46
0.4
0.2
0.0
Fresno Modesto Alameda Salinas San Francisco San Jose San Mateo Stockton
County County
Fig. 4. The surgical signature of spine surgery in 8 California hospital referral regions
(19961997). Patterns of spine surgery the surgical signatures of hospital referral regions
varied in idiosyncratic ways. This graph compares rates of three kinds of spine surgery in 8
California hospital referral regions to the national average [from 31, p. 44].
and about the same per capita numbers of spine surgeons can have very differ
ent signatures for spine surgery. Figure 4 shows the variation in spine surgery
in eight different hospital referral regions. The rate of lumbar discectomy was
41% higher than the national average in the Stockton, Calif. hospital referral
region, but the rate of decompression for lumbar stenosis was 7% lower than
the average. By contrast, the rate of lumbar discectomy in Fresno, Calif. was
39% below the average, but the rate of cervical spine surgery was 9% higher
than the national average. In San Jose, Calif. the rate of decompression was
54% below the average, but the rate of lumbar discectomy was only 2% below
the average [31].
Among the surgeons who performed spine surgery in Medicare enrollees in
1996, 3,011 were orthopedic surgeons and 2,934 were neurosurgeons. Overall,
neurosurgeons performed 64% of all spine surgery among Medicare enrollees,
compared to 36% by orthopedists. The proportion of spine surgery performed by
either neurosurgeons varied markedly among hospital referral regions, from 19%
in Akron, Ohio to 99% in Rapid City, S.D. The relative contributions of orthope
dists and neurosurgeons also varied widely according to the kind of procedure.
While neurosurgeons performed 85% of surgical procedures on the cervical spine,
they performed only 59% of decompressions for lumbar stenosis. Neurosurgeons
and orthopedic surgeons were quite different in their use of fusion for some types
of spine surgery. While both performed noninstrumented fusions in about one
third of cervical procedures, orthopedic surgeons were much more likely to
Burke/Gerszten 298
dramroo
Proportion of surgery using no fusion, uninstrumented
%
100 9% 3%
2% 8%
6% 21% 5%
27%
fusion, and fusion with hardware
80 43%
16%
60
32%
95%
85% 87%
40 32%
64%
20 42%
25%
0
Orthopedic Neuro Orthopedic Neuro Orthopedic Neuro
surgeons surgeons surgeons surgeons surgeons surgeons
Lumbar discectomy Lumbar decompression Cervical spine surgery
Fig. 5. Use of fusion (uninstrumented and with hardware) by orthopedists and neuro
surgeons in spine surgery, by indication (1996) [from 31, p. 49].
perform a fusion during lumbar procedures and were much more likely to perform
an instrumented fusion during both cervical and lumbar procedures (fig. 5) [31].
It has been said that next to the common cold, no condition afflicts the
American population with greater incidence and prevalence than LBP. Back pain
affects about 31 million people annually, and over 10 million people are disabled
because of back pain, with upwards of 250 million workdays lost per year. Over
USD 50 billion is expended on the management of back pain each year, with
approximately USD 11 billion of that in the workers compensation system. Two
thirds of Americans suffer an incapacitating episode of back pain at least once
in their lives, one third are suffering at any one time, and over one tenth are
seeking medical care [19]. An estimated 25% of American workers will experi
ence some back pain each year, with 5060% experiencing some disabling pain
during their working career [32]. While the annual rate for compensable back
pain is approximately 2%, this varies with occupation: less than 1% for admin
istrative and clerical personnel, and 115% for industrial workers [19].
Of the total money spent annually for the management of back pain, the
distribution of total direct costs is 45% for permanent disability payments,
References
1 Lawrence JS, Bremmer JN, Bier F: Osteoarthrosis: Prevalence in the population and relationship
between symptoms and x-ray changes. Ann Rheum Dis 1966;25:124.
2 Hadley MN, Robinson RD: Clinical assessment of degenerative disorders of the spine; in Tindall GT,
Cooper PR, Barrow DL (eds): The Practice of Neurosurgery. Philadelphia, Williams & Wilkins,
1996, pp 23672375.
3 Teresi LM, Lufkin RB, Reicher MA, Moffit BJ, Vinuela FV, Wilson GM, Bentson JR, Hanafee WN:
Asymptomatic degenerative disk disease and spondylosis of the cervical spine: MR imaging.
Radiology 1987;164:8388.
4 Clarke E, Robinson P: Cervical myelopathy: A complication of cervical spondylosis. Brain 1956;
79:483510.
5 Wilberger JE Jr, Chedid MK: Acute cervical spondylotic myelopathy. Neurosurgery 1988;22:
145146.
6 Zeidman SM, Ducker TB: Cervical disc disease. Neurosurg Q 1992;2:116163.
7 Love JG, Schorn VG: Thoracic disc protrusions. J Am Med Assoc 1965;191:9195.
8 Brennan M, Perrin JCS, Canady A, Wesolowski D: Paraparesis in a child with a herniated thoracic
disc. Arch Phys Med Rehabil 1987;68:806808.
9 Arce CA, Dohrmann GJ: Herniated thoracic disks. Neurol Clin 1985;3:383392.
10 De Villiers PD, Booysen EL: Fibrous spinal stenosis: A report on 850 myelograms with a water-
soluble contrast medium. Clin Orthop 1976;115:140144.
11 Roberson GH, Llewellyn HJ, Tavenas JM: The narrow lumbar spinal canal syndrome. Radiology
1973;107:8997.
12 Paine KWE: Clinical features of lumbar spinal stenosis. Clin Orthop 1976;115:7782.
Burke/Gerszten 300
dramroo
13 Getty CJM: Lumbar spinal stenosis: The clinical spectrum and the results of operation. J Bone
Joint Surg Br 1980;62:481485.
14 Epstein JA, Epstein BS, Lavine LS, Carras R, Rosenthal AD: Degenerative lumbar spondylolis
thesis with an intact neural arch (pseudospondylolisthesis). J Neurosurg 1976;44:139147.
15 Verbeist H: Pathomorphologic aspects of developmental lumbar stenosis. Orthop Clin North Am
1975;6:177196.
16 Hall S, Bartleson JD, Onofrio BM, Baker HL Jr, Okazaki H, ODuffy JD: Lumbar spinal steno
sis. Clinical features, diagnostic procedures, and results of surgical treatment in 68 patients. Ann
Intern Med 1985;103:271275.
17 Spengler DM: Degenerative stenosis of the lumbar spine. J Bone Joint Surg Am 1987;69:305308.
18 Rosenberg NJ: Degenerative spondylolisthesis. Predisposing factors. J Bone Joint Surg Am 1975;
57:467474.
19 Gerszten PG: The socioeconomic implications of neurosurgical disease; in Linskey ME,
Rutigliano MJ (eds): Quality & Costs in Neurological Surgery. Philadelphia, Lippincott, Williams
& Wilkins, 2001, pp 295302.
20 Hart LG, Deyo RA, Cherkin DC: Physician office visits for low back pain: Frequency, clinical
evaluation, and treatment patterns from a U.S. national survey. Spine 1995;20:1119.
21 Andersson GBJ: Epidemiological features of chronic low-back pain. Lancet 1999;354:581585.
22 Deyo RA, Weistein JN: Low back pain. N Engl J Med 2001;344:363370.
23 Kelsey JL, White AA: Epidemiology of low back pain. Spine 1980;6:133142.
24 Mitchell LV, Lawler FH, Bowen D, Mote W, Asundi P, Purswell J: Effectiveness and cost-effectiveness
of employer-issued back belts in areas of high risk for back injury. J Occup Med 1994;36:9094.
25 Coste J, Delecoeuillerie G, Cohen de Lara A, Le Parc JM, Paolaggi JB: Clinical course and prog
nostic factors in acute low back pain: An inception cohort study in primary care practice. BMJ
1994;308:577580.
26 Cherkin DC, Deyo RA, Street JH, Barlow W: Predicting poor outcomes for back pain seen in
primary care using patients own criteria. Spine 1996;21:29002907.
27 Croft PR, Macfarlane GJ, Papageorgiou AC, Thomas E, Silman AJ: Outcome of low back pain in
general practice: A prospective study. Br Med J 1998;316:13561359.
28 Deyo RA: Low-back pain. Sci Am 1998;279:4853.
29 Bozzao A, Gallucci M, Masciocchi C, Aprile I, Barile A, Passariello R: Lumbar disk herniation:
MR imaging assessment of natural history in patients treated without surgery. Radiology
1992;185:135141.
30 Atlas SJ, Chang Y, Kammann E, Keller RB, Deyo RA, Singer DE: Long-term disability and return
to work among patients who have a herniated lumbar disc: The effect of disability compensation.
J Bone Joint Surg Am 2000;82:415.
31 Weinstein JN, Birkmeyer JD: The Dartmouth Atlas of Musculoskeletal Health Care. The Trustees
of Dartmouth College, Dartmouth Medical School, 2000.
32 Watts C, Esser GB 3rd: Economic overview of spinal disorders; in Menezes AH, Sonntag VK
(eds): Principles of Spinal Surgery. New York, McGraw-Hill, 1996, pp 2536.
33 Conrad DA: Low back pain: Economic analysis of its impact on the U.S. non-elderly population; in
Bigos S (ed): Report of the Low Back Pain Guidelines Panel to the Office of the Forum of the Agency
for Health Care Policy and Research. Washington, Department of Health and Human Services, 1993.
34 Stripling TE: The cost of economic consequences of traumatic spinal cord injury. Paraplegia
News, August 1990, pp 5054.
35 DeVivo MJ: The cost of spinal cord injury: A growing national dilemma; in Apple DF Jr, Hydson
LM (eds): The Spinal Cord Injury Model: Proceedings of the National Consensus Conference on
Catastrophic Illness and Injury. Atlanta, 1989, pp 109113.
Tel. 1 412 647 3685, Fax 1 412 647 0989, E-Mail [email protected]
Spine Surgery
Gregory J. Przybylski
Seton Hall University, Orange, N.J., USA
dramroo
surgical procedures, the second version 4 years later expanded the description
of medical services using a five-digit coding system. The current fourth edition
was completed in 1977 and contained substantial revisions to include improve
ments in medical technology. Each year, the book is updated to reflect the elim
ination of older procedures that are no longer performed as well as the addition
of new procedures that reflect improvements in technology. The Health Care
Finance Administration (HCFA, now renamed CMS for the Centers for
Medicare and Medicaid Services) did not adopt CPT as part of their Common
Procedure Coding System (HCPCS) until 1983, after which it mandated use of
this system to report services for payment under Part B of the Medicare
program. Three years later, HCFA also required Medicaid agencies to use the
method.
The CPT system undergoes annual revision under the direction of the CPT
Editorial Panel. This 16-member panel meets quarterly and is comprised of 11
AMA-appointed physicians that serve 4-year terms. Four of these seats rotate
among specialists to allow a multidisciplinary influence. The other members of
the panel include the co-chairman of the Health Care Professionals Advisory
Committee (HCPAC), a representative from CMS, and appointees from the
Blue Cross and Blue Shield Association, the Health Insurance Association of
America, and the American Hospital Association. The panel is assisted by
AMA staff as well as the CPT Advisory Committee, which is comprised
predominantly of physicians selected by national medical specialty societies.
The largest change in CPT affecting the spine practitioner has been in the
reporting of anterior thoracolumbar spinal surgery performed by more than one
physician. With improvements in anesthetic technique and available instrumen
tation, greater attention had been drawn to anterior surgical approaches to spinal
diseases. Although some spinal surgeons perform their own thoracolumbar expo
sures, many utilize the expertise of other surgeons to perform the initial approach
to the anterolateral spinal column. Over several years, the American College of
Surgeons and Society of Thoracic Surgeons in cooperation with orthopedists and
neurosurgeons from 5 additional specialty societies worked to develop a consen
sus proposal to describe the approach component of anterior thoracolumbar spine
surgery. Using the model of skull base surgery that separated the approach from
the definitive procedure, emphasis was placed upon creating a scheme that would
allow separate coding of the surgical exposure and closure from the spinal
decompression or reconstruction. After several years of committee and work
group discussions and multiple presentations before the CPT Editorial Panel, the
surgical representatives concluded that the substantial variability in physician
practice made such a proposed system excessively complicated. Consequently, a
consensus proposal was presented to the CPT Editorial Panel in February of 2001
requesting an expanded application of the 62 co-surgery modifier.
Przybylski 304
dramroo
a comprehensive code would be paid while the component code would be
disallowed, whereas a small percentage of edits identified mutually exclusive
codes which would not be performed concurrently.
An example of the limitations of CCI placed on spinal surgery can be found
in posterior lumbar interbody fusion (PLIF, CPT code 22630). The service
description of posterior interbody fusion includes laminectomy, facetectomy,
and discectomy to approach and prepare the endplates for the interbody
arthrodesis. Consequently, CCI includes edits that preclude coding PLIF with
many decompression procedures. However, this does not account for circum
stances in which decompression is performed beyond the typically bony removal
required to perform a PLIF. An editorial revision to 22630 was instituted in 2001
that included only the laminar, facet and disk removal required for performance
of the PLIF, thereby allowing for coding of additional decompressive work if
performed and medically indicated. The CCI process prevents payment for these
additional physician services for the most part, unless a 59 modifier is also
appended to identify the code as a distinct procedural service from the PLIF.
This example distinguishes the differences between coding rules (developed and
maintained by the AMA) and reimbursement rules (developed individually by
CMS and third party payers).
However, the development of RBRVS has had the greatest impact upon the
billing practices of physicians this past decade after its full implementation on
January 1, 1996. The impetus to revise the Medicare payment system arose
from the rapidly increasing expenditures for payment of physician and hospital
services by Medicare. Since hospital services accounted for more than two
thirds of Medicare expenditures, cost containment efforts were naturally
directed at hospitals first. In 1983, a prospective pricing system (PPS) for hos
pital services using a diagnosis-related group (DRG) payment was developed
for approximately 500 diseases. Using the national average cost of hospital care
for that particular illness, it was assumed that the average cost for providing
care for patients with a range of illness severity would equal the calculated
DRG payment. Additional payments were also authorized to account for unusu
ally severe illnesses requiring prolonged hospital stays. Since the payment was
identical regardless of the hospital cost, the PPS provided a strong incentive for
hospitals to improve cost-efficiency. Not surprisingly, the annual growth of
Medicare expenditures was reduced by more than half between 1975 and 1990.
In 1994, physician payments on behalf of Medicare beneficiaries repre
sented more than three quarters of the expenditures from Medicare Part B [2].
The original method for determining the physician payment schedule was based
on customary, prevailing and reasonable (CPR) charges. This resembled the
usual, customary, and reasonable (UCR) charge system utilized by private insur
ers to pay for physicians services based upon their actual fees, but included
Przybylski 306
dramroo
phase of the national study supported development of an RBRVS for 12 physi
cian specialties. In addition, independent funding was obtained for the study of
6 additional specialties. Not only were specialty-specific scales developed, but
also a method for creating cross-specialty links allowed integration of a single
cross-specialty RBRVS. The Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act of 1986
provided a 2-year extension for submission of RBRVS to Congress as well as
mandated inclusion of 15 additional specialties during the second phase of the
study [710]. Although the AMA adopted in principle the results of the Harvard
study, they also recommended that the new Medicare payment system include
geographical differences in practice costs and professional liability as well as a
transition period to prevent disruptive changes between the CPR and RBRVS
systems. The PPRC likewise endorsed the study and supported these AMA
recommendations.
In December of 1989, Congress enacted the Omnibus Budget
Reconciliation Act (OBRA 89) that mandated a Medicare payment schedule
based on RBRVS from the Harvard study with inclusion of physician work,
practice expense, and professional liability costs. Geographical adjustments to
all three components were included. Calculation of a relative value unit (RVU)
of a physicians service under RBRVS is as follows:
35
30
25
USD
20
15
10
0
1993 1994 1995 1996 1997 1998 1999 2000 2001 2002
Year
Fig. 1. Change in Medicares surgical conversion factor over the past decade.
Przybylski 308
dramroo
value recommendations were made to HCFA with a recent acceptance rate of
more than 90%.
The spine practitioner can take advantage of the RBRVS system in deter
mining the cost required to provide physician services and thereby in developing
a fee schedule that reflects these costs. Although practice costs are not linearly
related to physician work, the RVU can serve as a surrogate. Consequently, a fee
schedule can be constructed based on a conversion factor determined by the
practice and applied to the RVU assigned by Medicare to procedural codes.
However, the appropriate conversion factor is influenced by many factors includ
ing personnel, equipment, and insurance (disability, health, malpractice) costs
among others. The practice manager should determine the average annual RVU
performed for the entire practice as well as stratified by individual physician.
As a result, simply dividing the total practice (or individual physician) costs by
the RVU performed during the same period provides a cost/RVU figure that
reflects the expense to provide physician services.
Determination of cost/RVU is essential in negotiating contracts with third-
party payers. Since many third-party payers have adopted fee schedules based
on RBRVS, it is to your advantage to determine your costs on a similar scale.
First of all, your analysis of the payment schedule is much more meaningful
once you have determined your practice cost to provide the service. Secondly,
the cost analysis allows the physician to focus on elements of the practice in
which costs can be reduced. Finally, one can assess the time required to perform
particular services. Certain services may be more economical than others,
thereby allowing the physicians to focus efforts on their most efficient services.
Although work values are resource-based, practice expense was based
upon the AMAs Socioeconomic Monitoring System 1989 Core Survey (SMS).
While overall practice costs including office rent, wages of nonphysician per
sonnel, equipment and supplies were measured, costs specific to a given single
procedural service were unknown. Moreover, practice expenses varied among
specialties. For example, these expenses represented 52.2% of family physi
cians practice costs but only 38.9% of neurosurgeons costs. In contrast, the
average neurosurgical professional liability component of practice cost was
7.6%, compared with a 3.9% proportion for the family physician. The method
enacted by OBRA 89 involved multiplying the specialty-specific practice
expense factor by the average Medicare payment of the service in 1991.
Similarly, professional liability was calculated based upon the proportion of
cost multiplied by the Medicare payment.
The Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act of 1993 mandated reductions in
the practice expense of overvalued services. Over a 3-year period, the practice
expense was reduced annually by 25% of the amount that the value exceeded the
physician work RVU until it was no greater than 128% of the work component.
Przybylski 310
dramroo
Societies meeting in 2001 revealed substantial increases in insurance costs in
the past year, which have led some physicians to curb practice or move to more
favorable geographical regions. For example, Indiana and California have
adopted tort reform legislation that includes caps on noneconomic damages that
have helped in reducing the unreasonable judgments awarded by some juries.
Unfortunately, CMS does not update the professional liability component of the
RVU on an annual basis, leading to a significant underestimation of these costs
for certain specialties including orthopedic and neurological surgery.
The AMA estimates that 12 states are currently experiencing a medical
liability crisis, whereas 30 additional states are on the verge of similar problems.
For example, the closure of a level 1 University Trauma Center in Las Vegas,
Nev. prompted the state legislature to temporarily give the physicians state
employee status, thereby limiting their liability to USD 50,000. The growing
liability crisis has prompted a bipartisan bill termed the Health Act that seeks
to institute national tort reform and includes limits on noneconomic damages
modeled after California and Indiana.
Finally, the increasing influence of governmental regulation on the practice
of medicine will continue to have a significant influence upon the manner in
which spinal surgeons provide health care. For example, the Kennedy-
Kassebaum Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act 1996 (HIPAA)
changed the US Governments Fraud and Abuse regulations by increasing civil
monetary damages from USD 2,000 to USD 10,000 and by applying fraud and
abuse laws to the private as well as the public sector, by permitting confiscation
of personal property for health care fraud convictions, and by changing health
care frauds from misdemeanors to federal felonies with mandatory prison sen
tences. Surgeons are liable for fraud and abuse violations in the documentation,
coding and billing tasks of their practice. Compliance plans and programs are
aimed at satisfying the Office of the Inspector Generals requirements for the
constant surveillance of these responsibilities. The requirement to comply with
the complex regulations that have evolved from the law begins next year and
poses a significant economic burden for smaller practices in developing and
maintaining compliance programs.
Similarly, the regulations that have arisen from the Emergency Medical
Treatment and Labor Act (EMTALA) of 1986 apply to physicians providing on-
call services to emergency departments. The requirements that have evolved
from the expanded interpretation of EMTALA include the need for the on-call
physician to arrive to the emergency department within 30 min of notification
of a true emergency. Possible violations of the act include inability to see a
patient at a second hospital if call is simultaneously taken at two hospitals and
both require concurrent patient evaluation and inability to leave an elective
procedure if a patient arrives in the emergency room requiring attention by
Przybylski 312
dramroo
environment that has both directly and indirectly affected the daily practice of
the spinal surgeon. An awareness of and adaptation to this changing environ
ment should help the spinal surgeon in meeting both the clinical demands of
treating patients with the economic constraints that may limit options going
forward. Increasing individual as well as professional societal involvement in
the legislative process is imperative to shaping a more favorable landscape for
practicing spinal surgery.
References
1 Gordon BL: Current Procedural Terminology. Chicago, American Medical Association, 1973.
2 Committee on Ways and Means: Overview of entitlement programs: 1994 Green Book. Washington,
Committee on Ways and Means, 1994, p 1075.
3 Burney IL, Schreiber GJ, Blaxall MO, Gabel JR: Geographic variation in physicians fees. JAMA
1978;240:13681371.
4 Mitchell JB: Physician DRGs. N Engl J Med 1985;313:670675.
5 Physician Payment Review Commission: Medicare physician payment: An agenda for reform;
in Annual Report to Congress No 68-227. Washington, US Government Printing Office, 1987.
6 Physician Payment Review Commission: Medicare physician payment; in Annual Report to
Congress. Washington, US Government Printing Office, 1988.
7 Hsiao WC, Braun P, Becker ER, Thomas SR: The resource based relative value scale. JAMA
1987;258:799802.
8 Hsiao WC, Braun P, Dunn D, Becker ER: Resource based relative values: An overview. JAMA
1988;260:23472353.
9 Hsiao WC, Braun P, Dunn D, Becker ER: Results and policy implications of the resource based
relative value study. N Engl J Med 1988;319:881888.
10 Hsiao WC, Braun P, Yntema D, Becker ER: Estimating physicians work for a resource-based rel
ative value scale. N Engl J Med 1988;319:835841.
11 Zimmerman R, Oster C: Insurers price wars contributed to doctors facing soaring costs. Wall
Street Journal, June 24, 2002.
12 Marcus MB: Healthcares perfect storm; soaring malpractice costs are causing critical shortages
of doctors. US News and World Report, July 1, 2002.
13 Healy WL, Iorio R, Lemos MJ, Patch DA, Pfeifer BA, Smiley PM, Wilk RM: Single price/case
price purchasing in orthopaedic surgery: Experience at the Lahey Clinic. J Bone Joint Surg Am
2000;82:607612.
Gregory J. Przybylski, MD
Tel. 1 732 632 1624, Fax 1 732 632 1584, E-Mail [email protected]
314
dramroo
Subject Index
vector 17, 18
vectors 1719
Adenovirus 17, 35
osteoinductive activities 2, 3
osteoinductive proteins 1, 15
Bone grafts
Bracing
cadaveric sources 30
adolescent idiopathic scoliosis 220
classification 31
Brain Lab system, virtual fluoroscopy
commercial products 31
7981
pros and cons of substances 32
40, 41
advantages 128, 136, 137, 140
3335
biomechanical characteristics
ideal properties 29
138
gene therapy
training 140
direct 19, 20
C1C2 screw fixation
overview 4, 16
screw placement 136
315
dramroo
C1C2 screw fixation (continued)
closure 261, 262
image guidance
complications and avoidance 262264
121
indications 252255
117119
operative setup 255257
development 176
Cervical pedicle screws
devices 178
C2 pars screw placement 158
manufacture 176
indications 163
radiolucency 176
Cervifix, posterior cervical lateral mass
Cervical laminoplasty
fixation 166
complications
Clinical Practice Expert Panel 310
contraindications 143
lumbar interbody fusion assessment 58,
indications 143
spinal stereotaxis 72, 73
kyphosis 142
thoracic pedicle screw placement 104,
outcomes 147149
189, 198
Z plasty 143
Computer-assisted fluoroscopy, see Virtual
and laminoforaminotomy
Current procedural terminology
advantages 251253
correct coding initiative limitations on
anesthesia 255
spinal surgery 305
254, 255
herpes virus 18
intraoperative 72
198
Accountability Act 311
advantages 45
Hydroxyapatite, coralline grafts 41, 42
foreign-body reactions 47
Image-guided spine surgery
prospects 51
anatomic landmarks 110
resorption 46
C1 lateral mass fixation 139
wear 45
cadaver testing 113
rhBMP-2 7
navigation 124, 125
Gene therapy
overview 113, 121, 123
equipment 74, 75
scoliosis 226
7476, 81
crisis 311
registration
Low back pain
purpose 111
LT cage
101
Lumbar interbody fusion
unreliability of intraoperative
advantages 277
scoliosis 226
laparoscopic approach
Kyphoplasty
overview 278
outcomes 246248
technique 279281
247
technique 282284
Kyphosis
postoperative care 285
epidemiology 291
assessment
64, 68
Lactosorb
computed tomography 58, 59, 6267
applications 47
device-bone interface 6163
implantation technique 48
dynamic plain radiographs 57, 58, 68
materials 45, 46
histologic biopsy 55
strength 48
segmental spinal stabilization 61
LT cage
see Vertical compression fracture
applications 7, 8
312
radiography 62, 63
strength 49
radiography in placement 71, 72, 84,
253, 254
percutaneous pedicle screw placement
laminoforaminotomy, Thoracic
indications 204, 205, 211
microendoscopic discectomy
K wire drilling 208
Osteoconduction
206, 207
bone grafts 2, 31
operating time 210, 211
definition 30
outcomes 210, 211
Osteogenesis
overview 204
growth factors 30
screw extender 208, 209
64, 68
stab incisions 208
overview 29, 30
virtual fluoroscopy 88, 89, 205, 206, 212
Osteoinduction
Percutaneous vertebroplasty
bone grafts 29
complications 243, 244
definition 30
contraindications 243
Osteolysis
development 242
prevalence 240
kyphoplasty comparison 247
Osteoporosis
pain relief mechanism 242, 243
prevalence 240
technique 242, 243
repair 44, 45
prospects for study 8, 9
32, 33
human studies 6, 7, 35, 64, 65
Polyglycolic acid
interbody spinal fusion animal
biocompatibility 47
models 6
degradation 45
posterolateral lumbar fusion animal
fixation devices 45
models 4, 5
Poly(L-lactic acid)
stem cell differentiation induction 3
biocompatibility 47
degradation 45, 48
Scheuermann disease, structural kyphosis
fixation devices 45, 46
222
tissue engineering 33
Scoliosis, see Thoracolumbar deformity
Polymethyl methacrylate
Segmental spinal stabilization, lumbar
tissue engineering 32
pedicle screw placement 208, 209
advantages 165
management 236, 237
Cervifix 166
fusion assessment 59, 60, 68
Starlock 166
economic impact 300
297, 298
Radiculopathy
296
surgery
Stealthstation, spinal stereotaxis 73
in dog models 15
adolescent idiopathic scoliosis
232, 233
266
231
indications 267269
233235
outcomes 273
double major curves 231, 232
269, 270
pedicle screws 227, 228
anatomy 98, 99
228231
assessment of placement 98
history 225
free-hand technique
treatment, nonoperative
exposure 190
adolescent idiopathic scoliosis 220
probe 193
kyphosis 222, 223
197, 198
for cervical spine 121
193, 196
bone repair 42, 43
training 202
Vitoss
preoperative planning 96
porosity 43
98, 104
VERTEX
Thoracolumbar deformity
229
evaluation
posterior cervical lateral mass fixation
history 214
screw placement 168170
radiography 216218
epidemiology 240